Expand preprocessor macros in C expressions.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
8a037dd7 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
959acfd1 34@set DATE December 2001
c906108c 35
6c0e9fb3 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
8a037dd7
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
54 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
59Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
6826cf00
EZ
63(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
64freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
65published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
66development.''
c906108c
SS
67@end ifinfo
68
69@titlepage
70@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
71@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 72@sp 1
c906108c
SS
73@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
74@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7
EZ
86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
5d161b24 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
8a037dd7 118Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 131* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 132* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
133
134* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
135
136* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
137* Altering:: Altering execution
138* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
139* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 140* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
141* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
142* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
143* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 144* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 147* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
148
149* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 155* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 156* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
157* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
158 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 159* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
160* Index:: Index
161@end menu
162
6c0e9fb3 163@end ifnottex
c906108c 164
449f3b6c 165@contents
449f3b6c 166
6d2ebf8b 167@node Summary
c906108c
SS
168@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
169
170The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
171going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
172program was doing at the moment it crashed.
173
174@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
175these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
176
177@itemize @bullet
178@item
179Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
180
181@item
182Make your program stop on specified conditions.
183
184@item
185Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
186
187@item
188Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
189effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
190@end itemize
191
cce74817 192You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 193For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
194For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
195
cce74817
JM
196@cindex Chill
197@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 198Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 199see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 200
cce74817
JM
201@cindex Pascal
202Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
203nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
204entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
205syntax.
c906108c 206
c906108c
SS
207@cindex Fortran
208@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 209it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 210underscore.
c906108c 211
c906108c
SS
212@menu
213* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
214* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
215@end menu
216
6d2ebf8b 217@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
218@unnumberedsec Free software
219
5d161b24 220@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
221General Public License
222(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
223program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
224freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
225the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
226Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
227Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
228
229Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
230you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
231from anyone else.
232
2666264b 233@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
234
235The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
236the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
237include with the free software. Many of our most important
238programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
239texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
240when an important free software package does not come with a free
241manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
242gaps today.
243
244Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
245normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
246authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
247copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
248them from the free software world.
249
250That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
251from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
252manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
253only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
254contract to make it non-free.
255
256Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
257price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
258charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
259Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
260problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
261are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
262modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
263
264The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
265free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
266commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
267accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
268
269Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
270When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
271are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
272provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
273manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
274a changed version of the program is not really available to our
275community.
276
277Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
278acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
279author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
280authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
281to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
282may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
283with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
284are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
285of the manual.
286
287However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
288content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
289media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
290obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
291manual to replace it.
292
293Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
294lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
295free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
296the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
297realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
298the free software community.
299
300If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
301the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
302license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
303don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
304will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
305option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
306what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
307try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 308is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
309
310You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
311manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
312copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
313improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
314at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
315and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
316Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
317have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
318
319The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
320published by other publishers, at
321@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
322
6d2ebf8b 323@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
324@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
325
326Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
327other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
328development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
329of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
330to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
331file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
332blow-by-blow account.
333
334Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
335
336@quotation
337@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
338or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
339omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
340@end quotation
341
342So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
343particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
344releases:
b37052ae 345Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
346Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
347Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
348Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
349Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
350Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
351John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
352Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
353and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
354
355Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
356Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
357
b37052ae
EZ
358Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
359in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
360Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
361demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
362much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 363
b37052ae 364@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
365object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
366Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
367
368David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
369the original support for encapsulated COFF.
370
96c405b3 371Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
372
373Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
374Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
375support.
376Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
377Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
378Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
379David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
380Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
381Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
382Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
383Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
384Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
385Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
386Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
387Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
388Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
389Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
390Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
391
392Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
393
394Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
395libraries.
396
397Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
398about several machine instruction sets.
399
400Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
401remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
402contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
403and RDI targets, respectively.
404
405Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
406command-line editing and command history.
407
7a292a7a
SS
408Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
409Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 410
5d161b24 411Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 412He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 413symbols.
c906108c
SS
414
415Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
416Super-H processors.
417
418NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
419
420Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
421
422Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
423
424Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
425
96a2c332 426Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
427
428Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
429watchpoints.
430
431Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
432
433Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
434
435Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 436nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
437
438The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
439support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 440(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
441compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
442John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
443Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
444information in this manual.
445
b37052ae
EZ
446DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
447Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
448
96a2c332
SS
449Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
450development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
451fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
452Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
453Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
454Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
455Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
456addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
457JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
458Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
459Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
460Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
461Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
462Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
463Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
464
465
6d2ebf8b 466@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
467@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
468
469You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
470However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
471debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
472
473@iftex
474In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
475to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
476@end iftex
477
478@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
479@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
480
481One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
482processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
483quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
484definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
485session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
486then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
487same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
488@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
489procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
490
491@smallexample
492$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
493$ @b{./m4}
494@b{define(foo,0000)}
495
496@b{foo}
4970000
498@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
499
500@b{bar}
5010000
502@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
503
504@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
505@b{baz}
506@b{C-d}
507m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
508@end smallexample
509
510@noindent
511Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
512
c906108c
SS
513@smallexample
514$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
515@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
516@c FIXME... format to come out better.
517@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 518 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 519 the conditions.
5d161b24 520There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
521 for details.
522
523@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
524(@value{GDBP})
525@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
526
527@noindent
528@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
529rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
530We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
531that examples fit in this manual.
532
533@smallexample
534(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
539Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
540@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
541@code{break} command.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
545Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
546@end smallexample
547
548@noindent
549Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
550control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
551subroutine, the program runs as usual:
552
553@smallexample
554(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
555Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
556@b{define(foo,0000)}
557
558@b{foo}
5590000
560@end smallexample
561
562@noindent
563To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
564suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
565context where it stops.
566
567@smallexample
568@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
569
5d161b24 570Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
571 at builtin.c:879
572879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
573@end smallexample
574
575@noindent
576Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
577the next line of the current function.
578
579@smallexample
580(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
581882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
582 : nil,
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
587by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
588@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
589subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
590
591@smallexample
592(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
593set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
594 at input.c:530
595530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
596@end smallexample
597
598@noindent
599The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
600suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
601shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
602command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
603in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
604stack frame for each active subroutine.
605
606@smallexample
607(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
608#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
609 at input.c:530
5d161b24 610#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
611 at builtin.c:882
612#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
613#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
614 at macro.c:71
615#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
616#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
617@end smallexample
618
619@noindent
620We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
621times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
622falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
623
624@smallexample
625(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6260x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
627(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6280x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
629def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
632 : xstrdup(rq);
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
634538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
635@end smallexample
636
637@noindent
638The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
639@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
640and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
641(@code{print}) to see their values.
642
643@smallexample
644(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
645$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
646(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
647$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
648@end smallexample
649
650@noindent
651@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
652To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
653surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
654
655@smallexample
656(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
657533 xfree(rquote);
658534
659535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
660 : xstrdup (lq);
661536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
662 : xstrdup (rq);
663537
664538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
665539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
666540 @}
667541
668542 void
669@end smallexample
670
671@noindent
672Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
673@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
674
675@smallexample
676(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
677539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
678(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
679540 @}
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
681$3 = 9
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
683$4 = 7
684@end smallexample
685
686@noindent
687That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
688@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
689@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
690the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
691any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
692assignments.
693
694@smallexample
695(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
696$5 = 7
697(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
698$6 = 9
699@end smallexample
700
701@noindent
702Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
703@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
704executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
705example that caused trouble initially:
706
707@smallexample
708(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
709Continuing.
710
711@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
712
713baz
7140000
715@end smallexample
716
717@noindent
718Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
719problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
720lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
721
722@smallexample
723@b{C-d}
724Program exited normally.
725@end smallexample
726
727@noindent
728The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
729indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
730session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
731
732@smallexample
733(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
734@end smallexample
c906108c 735
6d2ebf8b 736@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
737@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
738
739This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 740The essentials are:
c906108c 741@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 742@item
53a5351d 743type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 744@item
c906108c
SS
745type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
746@end itemize
747
748@menu
749* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
750* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
751* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
752@end menu
753
6d2ebf8b 754@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
755@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
756
c906108c
SS
757Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
758@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
759
760You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
761to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
762
c906108c
SS
763The command-line options described here are designed
764to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 765options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
766
767The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
768specifying an executable program:
769
474c8240 770@smallexample
c906108c 771@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 772@end smallexample
c906108c 773
c906108c
SS
774@noindent
775You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
776specified:
777
474c8240 778@smallexample
c906108c 779@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 780@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
781
782You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
783to debug a running process:
784
474c8240 785@smallexample
c906108c 786@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 787@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
788
789@noindent
790would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
791named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
792
c906108c 793Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
794complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
795debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
796``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
797will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 798
aa26fa3a
TT
799You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
800executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
801option processing.
474c8240 802@smallexample
aa26fa3a 803gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 804@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
805This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
806@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
807
96a2c332 808You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
809@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
810
811@smallexample
812@value{GDBP} -silent
813@end smallexample
814
815@noindent
816You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
817options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
818
819@noindent
820Type
821
474c8240 822@smallexample
c906108c 823@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 824@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
825
826@noindent
827to display all available options and briefly describe their use
828(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
829
830All options and command line arguments you give are processed
831in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
832@samp{-x} option is used.
833
834
835@menu
c906108c
SS
836* File Options:: Choosing files
837* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
838@end menu
839
6d2ebf8b 840@node File Options
c906108c
SS
841@subsection Choosing files
842
2df3850c 843When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
844specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
845the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
846@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
847first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
848equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
849second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
850equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
851If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
852first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
853to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
854a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 855prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
856
857If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
858such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
859argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
860
861Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
862following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
863them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
864(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
865than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
866
d700128c
EZ
867@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
868@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
869@c it.
870
c906108c
SS
871@table @code
872@item -symbols @var{file}
873@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
874@cindex @code{--symbols}
875@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
876Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
877
878@item -exec @var{file}
879@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--exec}
881@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
882Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
883and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
884
885@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 886@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
887Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
888file.
889
c906108c
SS
890@item -core @var{file}
891@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
892@cindex @code{--core}
893@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 894Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
895
896@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
897@item -pid @var{number}
898@itemx -p @var{number}
899@cindex @code{--pid}
900@cindex @code{-p}
901Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
902If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
903file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
904
905@item -command @var{file}
906@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
907@cindex @code{--command}
908@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
909Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
910Files,, Command files}.
911
912@item -directory @var{directory}
913@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
914@cindex @code{--directory}
915@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
916Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
917
c906108c
SS
918@item -m
919@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--mapped}
921@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
922@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
923supported on all systems.}@*
924If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 925system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
926to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
927program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 928called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
929Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
930and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
931the symbol table from the executable program.
932
933The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
934is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
935table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 936
c906108c
SS
937@item -r
938@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
939@cindex @code{--readnow}
940@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
941Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
942the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
943This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 944
c906108c
SS
945@end table
946
2df3850c 947You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 948order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
949information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
950on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
951but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 952
474c8240 953@smallexample
2df3850c 954gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 955@end smallexample
c906108c 956
6d2ebf8b 957@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
958@subsection Choosing modes
959
960You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
961batch mode or quiet mode.
962
963@table @code
964@item -nx
965@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
966@cindex @code{--nx}
967@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 968Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
969@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
970options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
971files}.
c906108c
SS
972
973@item -quiet
d700128c 974@itemx -silent
c906108c 975@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
976@cindex @code{--quiet}
977@cindex @code{--silent}
978@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
979``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
980messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
981
982@item -batch
d700128c 983@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
984Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
985command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
986initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
987nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
988in the command files.
989
2df3850c
JM
990Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
991example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
992make this more useful, the message
c906108c 993
474c8240 994@smallexample
c906108c 995Program exited normally.
474c8240 996@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
997
998@noindent
2df3850c
JM
999(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1000@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1001mode.
1002
1003@item -nowindows
1004@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1005@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1006@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1007``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1008(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1009interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1010
1011@item -windows
1012@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1013@cindex @code{--windows}
1014@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1015If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1016used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1017
1018@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1019@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1020Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1021instead of the current directory.
1022
c906108c
SS
1023@item -fullname
1024@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1025@cindex @code{--fullname}
1026@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1027@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1028subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1029number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1030displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1031recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1032the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1033and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1034@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1035frame.
c906108c 1036
d700128c
EZ
1037@item -epoch
1038@cindex @code{--epoch}
1039The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1040@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1041routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1042separate window.
1043
1044@item -annotate @var{level}
1045@cindex @code{--annotate}
1046This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1047effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1048(@pxref{Annotations}).
1049Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1050together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1051types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1052@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1053maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1054
1055@item -async
1056@cindex @code{--async}
1057Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1058@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1059special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1060commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1061run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1062MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1063suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1064control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1065(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1066operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1067yet.)
1068@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1069@c should be removed.
1070
1071When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1072uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1073@samp{-noasync} option.
1074
1075@item -noasync
1076@cindex @code{--noasync}
1077Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1078
aa26fa3a
TT
1079@item --args
1080@cindex @code{--args}
1081Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1082executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1083This option stops option processing.
1084
2df3850c
JM
1085@item -baud @var{bps}
1086@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1087@cindex @code{--baud}
1088@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1089Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1090interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1091
1092@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1093@itemx -t @var{device}
1094@cindex @code{--tty}
1095@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1096Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1097@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1098
53a5351d 1099@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1100@item -tui
1101@cindex @code{--tui}
1102Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1103The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1104showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1105(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1106Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1107(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1108
1109@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1110@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1111@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1112@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1113@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1114@c systems.
1115
d700128c
EZ
1116@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1117@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1118Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1119program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1120communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1121
1122@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1123@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1124@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1125@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1126
1127@item -write
1128@cindex @code{--write}
1129Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1130is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1131(@pxref{Patching}).
1132
1133@item -statistics
1134@cindex @code{--statistics}
1135This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1136memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1137
1138@item -version
1139@cindex @code{--version}
1140This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1141no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1142
c906108c
SS
1143@end table
1144
6d2ebf8b 1145@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1146@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1147@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1148@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1149
1150@table @code
1151@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1152@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1153@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1154@itemx q
1155To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1156@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1157do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1158otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1159error code.
c906108c
SS
1160@end table
1161
1162@cindex interrupt
1163An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1164terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1165returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1166character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1167until a time when it is safe.
1168
c906108c
SS
1169If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1170device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1171(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1172
6d2ebf8b 1173@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1174@section Shell commands
1175
1176If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1177debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1178just use the @code{shell} command.
1179
1180@table @code
1181@kindex shell
1182@cindex shell escape
1183@item shell @var{command string}
1184Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1185If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1186shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1187(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1188@end table
1189
1190The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1191You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1192@value{GDBN}:
1193
1194@table @code
1195@kindex make
1196@cindex calling make
1197@item make @var{make-args}
1198Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1199arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1200@end table
1201
6d2ebf8b 1202@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1203@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1204
1205You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1206name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1207@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1208key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1209show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1210
1211@menu
1212* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1213* Completion:: Command completion
1214* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1215@end menu
1216
6d2ebf8b 1217@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1218@section Command syntax
1219
1220A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1221how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1222arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1223command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1224step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1225with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1226
1227@cindex abbreviation
1228@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1229unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1230documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1231abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1232equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1233names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1234arguments to the @code{help} command.
1235
1236@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1237@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1238A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1239repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1240will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1241repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1242repeat.
1243
1244The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1245@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1246exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1247
1248@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1249output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1250(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1251@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1252repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1253
41afff9a 1254@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1255@cindex comment
1256Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1257nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1258Files,,Command files}).
1259
88118b3a
TT
1260@cindex repeating command sequences
1261@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1262The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1263commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1264then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1265for editing.
1266
6d2ebf8b 1267@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1268@section Command completion
1269
1270@cindex completion
1271@cindex word completion
1272@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1273only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1274are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1275commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1276
1277Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1278of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1279word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1280enter it). For example, if you type
1281
1282@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1283@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1284@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1285@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1286@smallexample
c906108c 1287(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1288@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1289
1290@noindent
1291@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1292the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1293
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1300breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1301@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1302were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1303might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1304to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1305
1306If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1307@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1308characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1309@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1310example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1311begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1312just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1313function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1314example:
1315
474c8240 1316@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1317(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1318@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1319make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1320make_abs_section make_function_type
1321make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1322make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1323make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1324(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1325@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1326
1327@noindent
1328After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1329partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1330command.
1331
1332If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1333can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1334means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1335key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1336one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1337
1338@cindex quotes in commands
1339@cindex completion of quoted strings
1340Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1341parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1342its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1343situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1344@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1345
c906108c 1346The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1347name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1348overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1349by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1350may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1351that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1352that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1353word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1354@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1355@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1356when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1357
474c8240 1358@smallexample
96a2c332 1359(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1360bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1361(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1362@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1363
1364In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1365quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1366completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1367place:
1368
474c8240 1369@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1370(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1371@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1372(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1373@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1374
1375@noindent
1376In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1377you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1378completion on an overloaded symbol.
1379
d4f3574e 1380For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1381expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1382overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1383see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1384
1385
6d2ebf8b 1386@node Help
c906108c
SS
1387@section Getting help
1388@cindex online documentation
1389@kindex help
1390
5d161b24 1391You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1392using the command @code{help}.
1393
1394@table @code
41afff9a 1395@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1396@item help
1397@itemx h
1398You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1399display a short list of named classes of commands:
1400
1401@smallexample
1402(@value{GDBP}) help
1403List of classes of commands:
1404
2df3850c 1405aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1406breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1407data -- Examining data
c906108c 1408files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1409internals -- Maintenance commands
1410obscure -- Obscure features
1411running -- Running the program
1412stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1413status -- Status inquiries
1414support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1415tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1416 stopping the program
c906108c 1417user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1418
5d161b24 1419Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1420commands in that class.
5d161b24 1421Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1422documentation.
1423Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1424(@value{GDBP})
1425@end smallexample
96a2c332 1426@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1427
1428@item help @var{class}
1429Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1430list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1431help display for the class @code{status}:
1432
1433@smallexample
1434(@value{GDBP}) help status
1435Status inquiries.
1436
1437List of commands:
1438
1439@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1440@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1441info -- Generic command for showing things
1442 about the program being debugged
1443show -- Generic command for showing things
1444 about the debugger
c906108c 1445
5d161b24 1446Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1447documentation.
1448Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1449(@value{GDBP})
1450@end smallexample
1451
1452@item help @var{command}
1453With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1454short paragraph on how to use that command.
1455
6837a0a2
DB
1456@kindex apropos
1457@item apropos @var{args}
1458The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1459commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1460@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1461
1462@smallexample
1463apropos reload
1464@end smallexample
1465
b37052ae
EZ
1466@noindent
1467results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1468
1469@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1470@c @group
1471set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1472 multiple times in one run
1473show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1474 multiple times in one run
1475@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1476@end smallexample
1477
c906108c
SS
1478@kindex complete
1479@item complete @var{args}
1480The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1481for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1482command you want completed. For example:
1483
1484@smallexample
1485complete i
1486@end smallexample
1487
1488@noindent results in:
1489
1490@smallexample
1491@group
2df3850c
JM
1492if
1493ignore
c906108c
SS
1494info
1495inspect
c906108c
SS
1496@end group
1497@end smallexample
1498
1499@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1500@end table
1501
1502In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1503and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1504of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1505manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1506under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1507all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1508
1509@c @group
1510@table @code
1511@kindex info
41afff9a 1512@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1513@item info
1514This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1515program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1516with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1517registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1518You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1519@w{@code{help info}}.
1520
1521@kindex set
1522@item set
5d161b24 1523You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1524@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1525@code{set prompt $}.
1526
1527@kindex show
1528@item show
5d161b24 1529In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1530@value{GDBN} itself.
1531You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1532related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1533system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1534which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1535
1536@kindex info set
1537To display all the settable parameters and their current
1538values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1539@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1540@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1541@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1542@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1543@end table
1544@c @end group
1545
1546Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1547exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1548
1549@table @code
1550@kindex show version
1551@cindex version number
1552@item show version
1553Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1554information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1555@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1556version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1557commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1558system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1559variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1560The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1561@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1562
1563@kindex show copying
1564@item show copying
1565Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1566
1567@kindex show warranty
1568@item show warranty
2df3850c 1569Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1570if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1571
c906108c
SS
1572@end table
1573
6d2ebf8b 1574@node Running
c906108c
SS
1575@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1576
1577When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1578debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1579
1580You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1581of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1582your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1583kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1584
1585@menu
1586* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1587* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1588* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1589* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1590
1591* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1592* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1593* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1594* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1595
1596* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1597* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1598@end menu
1599
6d2ebf8b 1600@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1601@section Compiling for debugging
1602
1603In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1604debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1605is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1606variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1607and addresses in the executable code.
1608
1609To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1610the compiler.
1611
1612Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1613options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1614executables containing debugging information.
1615
53a5351d
JM
1616@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1617without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1618recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1619program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1620in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1621
1622@cindex optimized code, debugging
1623@cindex debugging optimized code
1624When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1625optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1626really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1627exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1628variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1629variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1630
1631Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1632@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1633doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1634please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1635
1636Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1637@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1638format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1639
1640@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1641@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1642@section Starting your program
1643@cindex starting
1644@cindex running
1645
1646@table @code
1647@kindex run
41afff9a 1648@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1649@item run
1650@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1651Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1652You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1653argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1654@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1655(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1656
1657@end table
1658
c906108c
SS
1659If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1660supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1661that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1662@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1663
1664The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1665receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1666information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1667can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1668your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1669divided into four categories:
1670
1671@table @asis
1672@item The @emph{arguments.}
1673Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1674@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1675is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1676(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1677the arguments.
1678In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1679@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1680@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1681
1682@item The @emph{environment.}
1683Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1684use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1685environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1686your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1687
1688@item The @emph{working directory.}
1689Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1690the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1691@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1692
1693@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1694Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1695standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1696in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1697set a different device for your program.
1698@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1699
1700@cindex pipes
1701@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1702pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1703program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1704wrong program.
1705@end table
c906108c
SS
1706
1707When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1708immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1709of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1710stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1711or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1712
1713If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1714time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1715table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1716your current breakpoints.
1717
6d2ebf8b 1718@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1719@section Your program's arguments
1720
1721@cindex arguments (to your program)
1722The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1723@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1724They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1725performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1726@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1727@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1728the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1729
1730On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1731@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1732calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1733the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1734
1735@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1736@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1737
c906108c 1738@table @code
41afff9a 1739@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1740@item set args
1741Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1742@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1743with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1744using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1745it again without arguments.
1746
1747@kindex show args
1748@item show args
1749Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1750@end table
1751
6d2ebf8b 1752@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1753@section Your program's environment
1754
1755@cindex environment (of your program)
1756The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1757their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1758your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1759path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1760the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1761debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1762environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1763
1764@table @code
1765@kindex path
1766@item path @var{directory}
1767Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1768(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1769The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1770You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1771system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1772MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1773is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1774
1775You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1776working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1777use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1778@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1779@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1780@var{directory} to the search path.
1781@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1782@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1783
1784@kindex show paths
1785@item show paths
1786Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1787environment variable).
1788
1789@kindex show environment
1790@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1791Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1792your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1793print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1794your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1795
1796@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1797@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1798Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1799changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1800be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1801any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1802parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1803null value.
1804@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1805@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1806
1807For example, this command:
1808
474c8240 1809@smallexample
c906108c 1810set env USER = foo
474c8240 1811@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1812
1813@noindent
d4f3574e 1814tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1815@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1816are not actually required.)
1817
1818@kindex unset environment
1819@item unset environment @var{varname}
1820Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1821program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1822@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1823rather than assigning it an empty value.
1824@end table
1825
d4f3574e
SS
1826@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1827the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1828by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1829@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1830that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1831@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1832your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1833files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1834@file{.profile}.
1835
6d2ebf8b 1836@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1837@section Your program's working directory
1838
1839@cindex working directory (of your program)
1840Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1841working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1842The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1843from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1844working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1845
1846The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1847that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1848specify files}.
1849
1850@table @code
1851@kindex cd
1852@item cd @var{directory}
1853Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1854
1855@kindex pwd
1856@item pwd
1857Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1858@end table
1859
6d2ebf8b 1860@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1861@section Your program's input and output
1862
1863@cindex redirection
1864@cindex i/o
1865@cindex terminal
1866By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1867the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1868to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1869modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1870running your program.
1871
1872@table @code
1873@kindex info terminal
1874@item info terminal
1875Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1876program is using.
1877@end table
1878
1879You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1880redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1881
474c8240 1882@smallexample
c906108c 1883run > outfile
474c8240 1884@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1885
1886@noindent
1887starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1888
1889@kindex tty
1890@cindex controlling terminal
1891Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1892with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1893argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1894commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1895process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1896
474c8240 1897@smallexample
c906108c 1898tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1899@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1900
1901@noindent
1902directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1903default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1904that as their controlling terminal.
1905
1906An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1907effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1908terminal.
1909
1910When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1911command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1912for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1913
6d2ebf8b 1914@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1915@section Debugging an already-running process
1916@kindex attach
1917@cindex attach
1918
1919@table @code
1920@item attach @var{process-id}
1921This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1922outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1923targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1924find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1925or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1926
1927@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1928executing the command.
1929@end table
1930
1931To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1932which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1933programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1934also have permission to send the process a signal.
1935
1936When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1937the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1938the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1939(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1940the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1941Specify Files}.
1942
1943The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1944process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1945with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1946you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1947can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1948process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1949attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1950
1951@table @code
1952@kindex detach
1953@item detach
1954When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1955@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1956the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1957that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1958are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1959@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1960executing the command.
1961@end table
1962
1963If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1964attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1965for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1966control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1967confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1968messages}).
1969
6d2ebf8b 1970@node Kill Process
c906108c 1971@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1972
1973@table @code
1974@kindex kill
1975@item kill
1976Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1977@end table
1978
1979This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1980running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1981is running.
1982
1983On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1984while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1985@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1986outside the debugger.
1987
1988The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1989relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1990executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1991next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1992reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1993breakpoint settings).
1994
6d2ebf8b 1995@node Threads
c906108c 1996@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1997
1998@cindex threads of execution
1999@cindex multiple threads
2000@cindex switching threads
2001In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2002may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2003of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2004the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2005that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2006modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2007registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2008
2009@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2010programs:
2011
2012@itemize @bullet
2013@item automatic notification of new threads
2014@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2015@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2016@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2017a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2018@item thread-specific breakpoints
2019@end itemize
2020
c906108c
SS
2021@quotation
2022@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2023@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2024If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2025effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2026from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2027like this:
2028
2029@smallexample
2030(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2031(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2032Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2033see the IDs of currently known threads.
2034@end smallexample
2035@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2036@c doesn't support threads"?
2037@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2038
2039@cindex focus of debugging
2040@cindex current thread
2041The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2042threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2043control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2044This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2045program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2046
41afff9a 2047@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2048@cindex thread identifier (system)
2049@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2050@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2051@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2052Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2053the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2054form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2055whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2056LynxOS, you might see
2057
474c8240 2058@smallexample
c906108c 2059[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2060@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2061
2062@noindent
2063when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2064the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2065further qualifier.
2066
2067@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2068@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2069@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2070@c program?
2071@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2072@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2073@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2074
2075@cindex thread number
2076@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2077For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2078number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2079
2080@table @code
2081@kindex info threads
2082@item info threads
2083Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2084program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2085
2086@enumerate
2087@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2088
2089@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2090
2091@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2092@end enumerate
2093
2094@noindent
2095An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2096indicates the current thread.
2097
5d161b24 2098For example,
c906108c
SS
2099@end table
2100@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2101
2102@smallexample
2103(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2104 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2105 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2106* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2107 at threadtest.c:68
2108@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2109
2110On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2111
2112@cindex thread number
2113@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2114For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2115number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2116thread in your program.
2117
41afff9a
EZ
2118@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2119@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2120@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2121@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2122@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2123Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2124both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2125form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2126whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2127HP-UX, you see
2128
474c8240 2129@smallexample
c906108c 2130[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2131@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2132
2133@noindent
5d161b24 2134when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2135
2136@table @code
2137@kindex info threads
2138@item info threads
2139Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2140program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2141
2142@enumerate
2143@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2144
2145@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2146
2147@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2148@end enumerate
2149
2150@noindent
2151An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2152indicates the current thread.
2153
5d161b24 2154For example,
c906108c
SS
2155@end table
2156@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2157
474c8240 2158@smallexample
c906108c 2159(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2160 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2161 at quicksort.c:137
2162 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2163 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2164 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2165 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2166@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2170@item thread @var{threadno}
2171Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2172argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2173shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2174@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2175you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2176
2177@smallexample
2178@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2179(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2180[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21810x34e5 in sigpause ()
2182@end smallexample
2183
2184@noindent
2185As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2186@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2187threads.
c906108c
SS
2188
2189@kindex thread apply
2190@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2191The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2192more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2193with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2194@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2195threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2196@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2197@end table
2198
2199@cindex automatic thread selection
2200@cindex switching threads automatically
2201@cindex threads, automatic switching
2202Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2203signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2204signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2205message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2206thread.
2207
2208@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2209more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2210programs with multiple threads.
2211
2212@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2213watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2214
6d2ebf8b 2215@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2216@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2217
2218@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2219@cindex multiple processes
2220@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2221On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2222programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2223function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2224parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2225set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2226will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2227will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2228
2229However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2230which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2231the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2232only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2233so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2234on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2235get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2236@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2237the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2238the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2239
53a5351d
JM
2240On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2241debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2242@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2243
2244By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2245the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2246
2247If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2248use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2249
2250@table @code
2251@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2252@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2253Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2254@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2255process. The @var{mode} can be:
2256
2257@table @code
2258@item parent
2259The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2260unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262@item child
2263The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2264unimpeded.
2265
2266@item ask
2267The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2268@end table
2269
2270@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2271Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2272@end table
2273
2274If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2275@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2276breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2277@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2278the child process's @code{main}.
2279
2280When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2281child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2282
2283If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2284call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2285use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2286argument.
2287
2288You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2289a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2290Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2291
6d2ebf8b 2292@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2293@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2294
2295The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2296program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2297trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2298
7a292a7a
SS
2299Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2300such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2301@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2302change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2303continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2304ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2305explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2306
2307@table @code
2308@kindex info program
2309@item info program
2310Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2311running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2312@end table
2313
2314@menu
2315* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2316* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2317* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2318* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2319@end menu
2320
6d2ebf8b 2321@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2322@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2323
2324@cindex breakpoints
2325A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2326the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2327control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2328breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2329Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2330should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2331program.
2332
2333In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2334breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2335a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2336is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2337not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2338arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2339
2340@cindex watchpoints
2341@cindex memory tracing
2342@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2343@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2344A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2345when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2346command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2347watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2348any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2349and watchpoints using the same commands.
2350
2351You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2352whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2353Automatic display}.
2354
2355@cindex catchpoints
2356@cindex breakpoint on events
2357A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2358when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2359exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2360different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2361catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2362other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2363@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2364
2365@cindex breakpoint numbers
2366@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2367@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2368catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2369starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2370features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2371breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2372@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2373enable it again.
2374
c5394b80
JM
2375@cindex breakpoint ranges
2376@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2377Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2378operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2379@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2380hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2381all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2382
c906108c
SS
2383@menu
2384* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2385* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2386* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2387* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2388* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2389* Conditions:: Break conditions
2390* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2391* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2392* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2393@end menu
2394
6d2ebf8b 2395@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2396@subsection Setting breakpoints
2397
5d161b24 2398@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2399@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2400@c
2401@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2402
2403@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2404@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2405@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2406@cindex latest breakpoint
2407Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2408@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2409number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2410Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2411convenience variables.
2412
2413You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2414
2415@table @code
2416@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2417Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2418When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2419C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2420@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2421
2422@item break +@var{offset}
2423@itemx break -@var{offset}
2424Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2425at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2426(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2427
2428@item break @var{linenum}
2429Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2430The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2431The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2432code on that line.
2433
2434@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2435Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2436
2437@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2438Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2439@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2440superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2441functions.
2442
2443@item break *@var{address}
2444Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2445breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2446information or source files.
2447
2448@item break
2449When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2450the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2451(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2452innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2453returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2454@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2455that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2456@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2457the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2458inside loops.
2459
2460@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2461least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2462would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2463breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2464existed when your program stopped.
2465
2466@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2467Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2468@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2469value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2470@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2471above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2472,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2473
2474@kindex tbreak
2475@item tbreak @var{args}
2476Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2477same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2478way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2479program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2480
c906108c
SS
2481@kindex hbreak
2482@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2483Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2484@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2485breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2486have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2487debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2488changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2489provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2490will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2491address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2492breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2493example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2494@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2495or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2496(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2497
2498@kindex thbreak
2499@item thbreak @var{args}
2500Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2501are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2502the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2503the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2504first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2505command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2506may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2507See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2508
2509@kindex rbreak
2510@cindex regular expression
2511@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2512Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2513@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2514matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2515breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2516the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2517them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2518
2519The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2520like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2521shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2522an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2523@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2524match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2525
b37052ae 2526When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2527breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2528classes.
c906108c
SS
2529
2530@kindex info breakpoints
2531@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2532@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2533@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2534@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2535Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2536not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2537
2538@table @emph
2539@item Breakpoint Numbers
2540@item Type
2541Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2542@item Disposition
2543Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2544@item Enabled or Disabled
2545Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2546that are not enabled.
2547@item Address
2df3850c 2548Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2549@item What
2550Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2551line number.
2552@end table
2553
2554@noindent
2555If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2556the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2557are listed after that.
2558
2559@noindent
2560@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2561number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2562convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2563the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2564listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2565
2566@noindent
2567@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2568has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2569@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2570hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2571was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2572will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2573@end table
2574
2575@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2576your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2577the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2578(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2579
2580@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2581@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2582@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2583special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2584programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2585starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2586You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2587@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2588
2589
6d2ebf8b 2590@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2591@subsection Setting watchpoints
2592
2593@cindex setting watchpoints
2594@cindex software watchpoints
2595@cindex hardware watchpoints
2596You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2597expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2598this may happen.
2599
2600Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2601hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2602program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2603times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2604catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2605culprit.)
2606
d4f3574e 2607On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2608@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2609hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2610program.
2611
2612@table @code
2613@kindex watch
2614@item watch @var{expr}
2615Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2616is written into by the program and its value changes.
2617
2618@kindex rwatch
2619@item rwatch @var{expr}
2620Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2621
2622@kindex awatch
2623@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2624Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2625by the program.
c906108c
SS
2626
2627@kindex info watchpoints
2628@item info watchpoints
2629This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2630it is the same as @code{info break}.
2631@end table
2632
2633@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2634watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2635value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2636cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2637executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2638statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2639
2640When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2641
474c8240 2642@smallexample
c906108c 2643Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2644@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2645
2646@noindent
2647if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2648
7be570e7
JM
2649Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2650hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2651value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2652every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2653that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2654hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2655will print a message like this:
2656
2657@smallexample
2658Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2659@end smallexample
2660
2661Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2662data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2663watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2664can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2665cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2666double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2667wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2668into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2669
2670If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2671to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2672Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2673time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2674able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2675warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2676
2677@smallexample
2678Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2679@end smallexample
2680
2681@noindent
2682If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2683
2684The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2685or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2686data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2687hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2688both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2689watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2690@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2691watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2692@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2693Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2694
2695If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2696any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2697kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2698
7be570e7
JM
2699@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2700(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2701they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2702which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2703being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2704and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2705rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2706way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2707@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2708
c906108c
SS
2709@quotation
2710@cindex watchpoints and threads
2711@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2712@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2713usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2714can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2715you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2716thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2717can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2718@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2719the expression.
53a5351d 2720
d4f3574e 2721@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2722@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2723have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2724watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2725single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2726change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2727confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2728software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2729when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2730watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2731@end quotation
c906108c 2732
6d2ebf8b 2733@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2734@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2735@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2736@cindex exception handlers
2737@cindex event handling
2738
2739You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2740kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2741shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2742
2743@table @code
2744@kindex catch
2745@item catch @var{event}
2746Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2747@table @code
2748@item throw
2749@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2750The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2751
2752@item catch
2753@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2754The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2755
2756@item exec
2757@kindex catch exec
2758A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2759
2760@item fork
2761@kindex catch fork
2762A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2763
2764@item vfork
2765@kindex catch vfork
2766A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2767
2768@item load
2769@itemx load @var{libname}
2770@kindex catch load
2771The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2772@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2773
2774@item unload
2775@itemx unload @var{libname}
2776@kindex catch unload
2777The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2778of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2779@end table
2780
2781@item tcatch @var{event}
2782Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2783automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2784
2785@end table
2786
2787Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2788
b37052ae 2789There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2790(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2791
2792@itemize @bullet
2793@item
2794If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2795control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2796raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2797returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2798simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2799that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2800you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2801disabled within interactive calls.
2802
2803@item
2804You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2805
2806@item
2807You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2808@end itemize
2809
2810@cindex raise exceptions
2811Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2812if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2813stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2814can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2815breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2816out where the exception was raised.
2817
2818To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2819knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2820raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2821which has the following ANSI C interface:
2822
474c8240 2823@smallexample
c906108c 2824 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2825 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2826 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2827@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2828
2829@noindent
2830To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2831unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2832(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2833
2834With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2835that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2836a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2837breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2838raised.
2839
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2843
2844@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2845@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2846It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2847catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2848to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2849breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2850
2851With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2852where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2853delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2854their breakpoint numbers.
2855
2856It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2857automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2858when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2859
2860@table @code
2861@kindex clear
2862@item clear
2863Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2864selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2865the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2866breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2867
2868@item clear @var{function}
2869@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2870Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2871
2872@item clear @var{linenum}
2873@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2874Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2875
2876@cindex delete breakpoints
2877@kindex delete
41afff9a 2878@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2879@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2880Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2881ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2882breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2883confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2884@end table
2885
6d2ebf8b 2886@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2887@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2888
2889@kindex disable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable breakpoints
2891Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2892prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2893it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2894that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2895
2896You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2897the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2898or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2899@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2900catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2901
2902A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2903states of enablement:
2904
2905@itemize @bullet
2906@item
2907Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2908with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2909@item
2910Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2911@item
2912Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2913disabled.
c906108c
SS
2914@item
2915Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2916immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2917set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2918@end itemize
2919
2920You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2921watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2922
2923@table @code
2924@kindex disable breakpoints
2925@kindex disable
41afff9a 2926@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2927@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2928Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2929listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2930options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2931case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2932@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2933
2934@kindex enable breakpoints
2935@kindex enable
c5394b80 2936@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2937Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2938become effective once again in stopping your program.
2939
c5394b80 2940@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2941Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2942of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2943
c5394b80 2944@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2945Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2946deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2947@end table
2948
d4f3574e
SS
2949@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2950@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2951Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2952,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2953subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2954the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2955breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2956breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2957stepping}.)
2958
6d2ebf8b 2959@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2960@subsection Break conditions
2961@cindex conditional breakpoints
2962@cindex breakpoint conditions
2963
2964@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2965@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2966The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2967specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2968breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2969programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2970a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2971and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2972
2973This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2974situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2975when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2976by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2977@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2978
2979Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2980since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2981it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2982and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2983one.
2984
2985Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2986your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2987that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2988format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2989unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2990that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2991program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2992breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2993conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2994purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2995(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2996
2997Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2998@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2999Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3000with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3001
c906108c
SS
3002You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3003The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3004@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3005catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3006
3007@table @code
3008@kindex condition
3009@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3010Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3011watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3012breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3013@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3014@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3015syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3016referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3017symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3018prints an error message:
3019
474c8240 3020@smallexample
d4f3574e 3021No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3022@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3023
3024@noindent
c906108c
SS
3025@value{GDBN} does
3026not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3027command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3028@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3029
3030@item condition @var{bnum}
3031Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3032an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3033@end table
3034
3035@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3036A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3037breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3038useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3039count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3040is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3041therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3042ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3043the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3044value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3045your program reaches it.
3046
3047@table @code
3048@kindex ignore
3049@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3050Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3051The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3052execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3053takes no action.
3054
3055To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3056a count of zero.
3057
3058When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3059breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3060@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3061Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3062
3063If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3064condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3065@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3066
3067You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3068as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3069is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3070variables}.
3071@end table
3072
3073Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3074
3075
6d2ebf8b 3076@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3077@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3078
3079@cindex breakpoint commands
3080You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3081commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3082example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3083enable other breakpoints.
3084
3085@table @code
3086@kindex commands
3087@kindex end
3088@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3089@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3090@itemx end
3091Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3092themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3093@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3094
3095To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3096follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3097
3098With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3099breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3100recently encountered).
3101@end table
3102
3103Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3104disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3105
3106You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3107use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3108that resumes execution.
3109
3110Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3111execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3112(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3113another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3114ambiguities about which list to execute.
3115
3116@kindex silent
3117If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3118usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3119be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3120then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3121see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3122meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3123
3124The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3125print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3126breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3127
3128For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3129value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3130
474c8240 3131@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3132break foo if x>0
3133commands
3134silent
3135printf "x is %d\n",x
3136cont
3137end
474c8240 3138@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3139
3140One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3141you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3142of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3143erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3144to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3145so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3146command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3147
474c8240 3148@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3149break 403
3150commands
3151silent
3152set x = y + 4
3153cont
3154end
474c8240 3155@end smallexample
c906108c 3156
6d2ebf8b 3157@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3158@subsection Breakpoint menus
3159@cindex overloading
3160@cindex symbol overloading
3161
b37052ae 3162Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3163to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3164This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3165@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3166a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3167something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3168particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3169you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3170waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3171options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3172sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3173@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3174breakpoints.
3175
3176For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3177breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3178We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3179
3180@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3181@smallexample
3182@group
3183(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3184[0] cancel
3185[1] all
3186[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3187[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3188[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3189[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3190[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3191[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3192> 2 4 6
3193Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3194Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3195Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3196Multiple breakpoints were set.
3197Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3198 breakpoints.
3199(@value{GDBP})
3200@end group
3201@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3202
3203@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3204@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3205@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3206@c
3207@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3208@c
d4f3574e
SS
3209Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3210any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3211attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3212@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3213
474c8240 3214@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3215Cannot insert breakpoints.
3216The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3217@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3218
3219When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3220
3221@enumerate
3222@item
3223Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3224
3225@item
5d161b24 3226Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3227name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3228that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3229Then start your program again.
3230
3231@item
3232Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3233linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3234to nonsharable executables.
3235@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3236@c @end ifclear
3237
d4f3574e
SS
3238A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3239hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3240
3241@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3242@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3243@smallexample
3244Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3245You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3246@end smallexample
3247
3248@noindent
3249This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3250only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3251watchpoints it needs to insert.
3252
3253When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3254hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3255
3256
6d2ebf8b 3257@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3258@section Continuing and stepping
3259
3260@cindex stepping
3261@cindex continuing
3262@cindex resuming execution
3263@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3264completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3265one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3266line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3267particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3268your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3269it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3270@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3271
3272@table @code
3273@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3274@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3275@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3276@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3277@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3278@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3279Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3280any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3281@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3282ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3283@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3284
3285The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3286stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3287@code{continue} is ignored.
3288
d4f3574e
SS
3289The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3290debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3291purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3292@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3293@end table
3294
3295To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3296(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3297calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3298different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3299
3300A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3301(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3302beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3303is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3304and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3305interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3306
3307@table @code
3308@kindex step
41afff9a 3309@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3310@item step
3311Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3312line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3313abbreviated @code{s}.
3314
3315@quotation
3316@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3317@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3318@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3319@c distinction here.
3320@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3321within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3322execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3323debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3324is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3325without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3326below.
3327@end quotation
3328
4a92d011
EZ
3329The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3330line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3331@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3332to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3333the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3334called within the line.
c906108c 3335
d4f3574e
SS
3336Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3337number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3338@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3339on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3340was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3341
3342@item step @var{count}
3343Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3344breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3345@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3346
3347@kindex next
41afff9a 3348@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3349@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3350Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3351This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3352the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3353control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3354that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3355is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3356
3357An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3358
3359
3360@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3361@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3362@c
3363@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3364@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3365@c function are executed without stopping.
3366
d4f3574e
SS
3367The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3368source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3369@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3370
b90a5f51
CF
3371@kindex set step-mode
3372@item set step-mode
3373@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3374@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3375@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3376The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3377stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3378information rather than stepping over it.
3379
4a92d011
EZ
3380This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3381machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3382want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3383
3384@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3385Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3386debug information. This is the default.
3387
c906108c
SS
3388@kindex finish
3389@item finish
3390Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3391returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3392
3393Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3394,Returning from a function}).
3395
3396@kindex until
41afff9a 3397@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3398@item until
3399@itemx u
3400Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3401current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3402stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3403command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3404automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3405than the address of the jump.
3406
3407This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3408though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3409exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3410simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3411through the next iteration.
3412
3413@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3414stack frame.
3415
3416@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3417of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3418example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3419(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3420@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3421
474c8240 3422@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3423(@value{GDBP}) f
3424#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3425206 expand_input();
3426(@value{GDBP}) until
3427195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3428@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3429
3430This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3431generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3432start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3433written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3434to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3435expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3436statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3437
3438@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3439instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3440argument.
3441
3442@item until @var{location}
3443@itemx u @var{location}
3444Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3445reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3446the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3447,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3448and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3449
3450@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3451@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3452@item stepi
96a2c332 3453@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3454@itemx si
3455Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3456
3457It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3458instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3459instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3460Display,, Automatic display}.
3461
3462An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3463
3464@need 750
3465@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3466@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3467@item nexti
96a2c332 3468@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3469@itemx ni
3470Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3471proceed until the function returns.
3472
3473An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3474@end table
3475
6d2ebf8b 3476@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3477@section Signals
3478@cindex signals
3479
3480A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3481operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3482kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3483signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3484@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3485memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3486the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3487requested an alarm).
3488
3489@cindex fatal signals
3490Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3491functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3492errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3493program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3494@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3495fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3496
3497@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3498program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3499signal.
3500
3501@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3502Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3503@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3504(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3505but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3506You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3507
3508@table @code
3509@kindex info signals
3510@item info signals
96a2c332 3511@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3512Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3513handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3514the defined types of signals.
3515
d4f3574e 3516@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3517
3518@kindex handle
3519@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3520Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3521can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3522@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3523@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3524known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3525@end table
3526
3527@c @group
3528The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3529Their full names are:
3530
3531@table @code
3532@item nostop
3533@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3534still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3535
3536@item stop
3537@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3538the @code{print} keyword as well.
3539
3540@item print
3541@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3542
3543@item noprint
3544@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3545implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3546
3547@item pass
5ece1a18 3548@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3549@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3550can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3551and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3552
3553@item nopass
5ece1a18 3554@itemx ignore
c906108c 3555@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3556@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3557@end table
3558@c @end group
3559
d4f3574e
SS
3560When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3561program until you
c906108c
SS
3562continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3563effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3564after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3565command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3566program sees that signal when you continue.
3567
24f93129
EZ
3568The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3569non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3570@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3571erroneous signals.
3572
c906108c
SS
3573You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3574seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3575or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3576due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3577values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3578execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3579a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3580you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3581program a signal}.
c906108c 3582
6d2ebf8b 3583@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3584@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3585
3586When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3587programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3588breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3589
3590@table @code
3591@cindex breakpoints and threads
3592@cindex thread breakpoints
3593@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3594@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3595@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3596@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3597writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3598
3599Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3600to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3601particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3602numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3603column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3604
3605If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3606breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3607program.
3608
3609You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3610well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3611breakpoint condition, like this:
3612
3613@smallexample
2df3850c 3614(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3615@end smallexample
3616
3617@end table
3618
3619@cindex stopped threads
3620@cindex threads, stopped
3621Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3622@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3623allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3624switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3625underfoot.
3626
3627@cindex continuing threads
3628@cindex threads, continuing
3629Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3630executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3631like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3632
3633In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3634Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3635system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3636execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3637single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3638statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3639stops.
3640
3641You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3642continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3643thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3644first thread completes whatever you requested.
3645
3646On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3647thread to run.
3648
3649@table @code
3650@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3651Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3652locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3653current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3654mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3655``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3656stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3657when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3658function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3659like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3660thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3661@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3662
3663@item show scheduler-locking
3664Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3665@end table
3666
c906108c 3667
6d2ebf8b 3668@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3669@chapter Examining the Stack
3670
3671When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3672stopped and how it got there.
3673
3674@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3675Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3676is generated.
3677That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3678the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3679and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3680The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3681The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3682stack}.
3683
3684When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3685stack allow you to see all of this information.
3686
3687@cindex selected frame
3688One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3689@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3690particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3691your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3692special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3693interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3694
3695When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3696currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3697@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3698
3699@menu
3700* Frames:: Stack frames
3701* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3702* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3703* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3704
3705@end menu
3706
6d2ebf8b 3707@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3708@section Stack frames
3709
d4f3574e 3710@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3711@cindex stack frame
3712The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3713frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3714with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3715to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3716which the function is executing.
3717
3718@cindex initial frame
3719@cindex outermost frame
3720@cindex innermost frame
3721When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3722function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3723@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3724made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3725is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3726the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3727actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3728recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3729
3730@cindex frame pointer
3731Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3732stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3733kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3734address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3735in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3736going on in that frame.
3737
3738@cindex frame number
3739@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3740zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3741and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3742they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3743frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3744
6d2ebf8b
SS
3745@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3746@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3747@cindex frameless execution
3748Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3749without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3750@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3751@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3752@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3753generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3754This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3755the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3756with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3757has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3758it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3759correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3760no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3761
3762@table @code
d4f3574e 3763@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3764@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3765@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3766The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3767and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3768address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3769@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3770
3771@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3772@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3773@item select-frame
3774The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3775to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3776@code{frame}.
3777@end table
3778
6d2ebf8b 3779@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3780@section Backtraces
3781
3782@cindex backtraces
3783@cindex tracebacks
3784@cindex stack traces
3785A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3786line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3787frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3788stack.
3789
3790@table @code
3791@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3792@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3793@item backtrace
3794@itemx bt
3795Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3796frames in the stack.
3797
3798You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3799character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3800
3801@item backtrace @var{n}
3802@itemx bt @var{n}
3803Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3804
3805@item backtrace -@var{n}
3806@itemx bt -@var{n}
3807Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3808@end table
3809
3810@kindex where
3811@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3812@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3813The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3814are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3815
3816Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3817The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3818print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3819line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3820counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3821line number.
3822
3823Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3824@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3825
3826@smallexample
3827@group
5d161b24 3828#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3829 at builtin.c:993
3830#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3831#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3832 at macro.c:71
3833(More stack frames follow...)
3834@end group
3835@end smallexample
3836
3837@noindent
3838The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3839value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3840code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3841
6d2ebf8b 3842@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3843@section Selecting a frame
3844
3845Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3846whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3847selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3848of the stack frame just selected.
3849
3850@table @code
d4f3574e 3851@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3852@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3853@item frame @var{n}
3854@itemx f @var{n}
3855Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3856(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3857innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3858@code{main}.
3859
3860@item frame @var{addr}
3861@itemx f @var{addr}
3862Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3863chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3864impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3865addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3866switches between them.
3867
c906108c
SS
3868On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3869select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3870
3871On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3872pointer and a program counter.
3873
3874On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3875pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3876@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3877@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3878@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3879
3880@kindex up
3881@item up @var{n}
3882Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3883advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3884that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3885
3886@kindex down
41afff9a 3887@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3888@item down @var{n}
3889Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3890advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3891that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3892abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3893@end table
3894
3895All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3896frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3897arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3898frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3899
3900@need 1000
3901For example:
3902
3903@smallexample
3904@group
3905(@value{GDBP}) up
3906#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3907 at env.c:10
390810 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3909@end group
3910@end smallexample
3911
3912After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3913prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3914@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3915
3916@table @code
3917@kindex down-silently
3918@kindex up-silently
3919@item up-silently @var{n}
3920@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3921These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3922respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3923causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3924in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3925distracting.
3926@end table
3927
6d2ebf8b 3928@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3929@section Information about a frame
3930
3931There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3932stack frame.
3933
3934@table @code
3935@item frame
3936@itemx f
3937When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3938frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3939selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3940argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3941@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3942
3943@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3944@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3945@item info frame
3946@itemx info f
3947This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3948including:
3949
3950@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3951@item
3952the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3953@item
3954the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3955@item
3956the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3957@item
3958the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3959@item
3960the address of the frame's arguments
3961@item
d4f3574e
SS
3962the address of the frame's local variables
3963@item
c906108c
SS
3964the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3965@item
3966which registers were saved in the frame
3967@end itemize
3968
3969@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3970something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3971the usual conventions.
3972
3973@item info frame @var{addr}
3974@itemx info f @var{addr}
3975Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3976selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3977command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3978architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3979@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3980
3981@kindex info args
3982@item info args
3983Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3984
3985@item info locals
3986@kindex info locals
3987Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3988line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3989accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3990
c906108c 3991@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3992@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3993@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3994@item info catch
3995Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3996current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3997exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3998@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3999@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4000
c906108c
SS
4001@end table
4002
c906108c 4003
6d2ebf8b 4004@node Source
c906108c
SS
4005@chapter Examining Source Files
4006
4007@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4008information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4009used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4010the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4011(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4012execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4013source files by explicit command.
4014
7a292a7a 4015If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4016prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4017@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4018
4019@menu
4020* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 4021* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4022* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4023* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4024@end menu
4025
6d2ebf8b 4026@node List
c906108c
SS
4027@section Printing source lines
4028
4029@kindex list
41afff9a 4030@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4031To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4032(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4033There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4034
4035Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4036
4037@table @code
4038@item list @var{linenum}
4039Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4040current source file.
4041
4042@item list @var{function}
4043Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4044@var{function}.
4045
4046@item list
4047Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4048@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4049printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4050as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4051Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4052
4053@item list -
4054Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4055@end table
4056
4057By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4058the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4059
4060@table @code
4061@kindex set listsize
4062@item set listsize @var{count}
4063Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4064the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4065
4066@kindex show listsize
4067@item show listsize
4068Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4069@end table
4070
4071Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4072so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4073than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4074argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4075each repetition moves up in the source file.
4076
4077@cindex linespec
4078In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4079@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4080of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4081Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4082
4083@table @code
4084@item list @var{linespec}
4085Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4086
4087@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4088Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4089linespecs.
4090
4091@item list ,@var{last}
4092Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4093
4094@item list @var{first},
4095Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4096
4097@item list +
4098Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4099
4100@item list -
4101Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4102
4103@item list
4104As described in the preceding table.
4105@end table
4106
4107Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4108kinds of linespec.
4109
4110@table @code
4111@item @var{number}
4112Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4113When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4114the same source file as the first linespec.
4115
4116@item +@var{offset}
4117Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4118When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4119two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4120first linespec.
4121
4122@item -@var{offset}
4123Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4124
4125@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4126Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4127
4128@item @var{function}
4129Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4130For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4131
4132@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4133Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4134function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4135file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4136identically named functions in different source files.
4137
4138@item *@var{address}
4139Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4140@var{address} may be any expression.
4141@end table
4142
6d2ebf8b 4143@node Search
c906108c
SS
4144@section Searching source files
4145@cindex searching
4146@kindex reverse-search
4147
4148There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4149regular expression.
4150
4151@table @code
4152@kindex search
4153@kindex forward-search
4154@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4155@itemx search @var{regexp}
4156The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4157starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4158@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4159synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4160@code{fo}.
4161
4162@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4163The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4164with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4165for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4166this command as @code{rev}.
4167@end table
c906108c 4168
6d2ebf8b 4169@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4170@section Specifying source directories
4171
4172@cindex source path
4173@cindex directories for source files
4174Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4175files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4176the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4177session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4178this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4179it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4180in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4181the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4182the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4183path.
4184
4185If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4186object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4187too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4188compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4189last resort.
4190
4191Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4192any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4193each line is in the file.
4194
4195@kindex directory
4196@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4197When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4198and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4199To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4200
4201@table @code
4202@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4203@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4204Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4205directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4206(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4207part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4208whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4209path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4210
4211@kindex cdir
4212@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4213@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4214@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4215@cindex compilation directory
4216@cindex current directory
4217@cindex working directory
4218@cindex directory, current
4219@cindex directory, compilation
4220You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4221directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4222working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4223tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4224session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4225directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4226
4227@item directory
4228Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4229
4230@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4231@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4232
4233@item show directories
4234@kindex show directories
4235Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4236@end table
4237
4238If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4239interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4240versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4241
4242@enumerate
4243@item
4244Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4245
4246@item
4247Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4248directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4249directories in one command.
4250@end enumerate
4251
6d2ebf8b 4252@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4253@section Source and machine code
4254
4255You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4256addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4257a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4258mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4259line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4260well as hex.
4261
4262@table @code
4263@kindex info line
4264@item info line @var{linespec}
4265Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4266source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4267the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4268source lines}).
4269@end table
4270
4271For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4272the object code for the first line of function
4273@code{m4_changequote}:
4274
d4f3574e
SS
4275@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4276@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4277@smallexample
96a2c332 4278(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4279Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4280@end smallexample
4281
4282@noindent
4283We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4284@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4285@smallexample
4286(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4287Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4288@end smallexample
4289
4290@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4291@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4292After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4293is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4294sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4295,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4296convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4297variables}).
4298
4299@table @code
4300@kindex disassemble
4301@cindex assembly instructions
4302@cindex instructions, assembly
4303@cindex machine instructions
4304@cindex listing machine instructions
4305@item disassemble
4306This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4307instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4308program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4309command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4310surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4311(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4312@end table
4313
c906108c
SS
4314The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4315HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4316
4317@smallexample
4318(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4319Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
43200x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
43210x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
43220x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
43230x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
43240x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
43250x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
43260x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
43270x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4328End of assembler dump.
4329@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4330
4331Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4332mnemonics or other syntax.
4333
4334@table @code
d4f3574e 4335@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4336@cindex assembly instructions
4337@cindex instructions, assembly
4338@cindex machine instructions
4339@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4340@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4341@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4342@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4343Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4344program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4345
4346Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4347can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4348The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4349assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4350@end table
4351
4352
6d2ebf8b 4353@node Data
c906108c
SS
4354@chapter Examining Data
4355
4356@cindex printing data
4357@cindex examining data
4358@kindex print
4359@kindex inspect
4360@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4361@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4362@c different window or something like that.
4363The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4364command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4365evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4366program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4367Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4368
4369@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4370@item print @var{expr}
4371@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4372@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4373value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4374you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4375@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4376formats}.
4377
4378@item print
4379@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4380If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4381@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4382conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4383@end table
4384
4385A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4386It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4387specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4388
7a292a7a 4389If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4390fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4391command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4392Table}.
c906108c
SS
4393
4394@menu
4395* Expressions:: Expressions
4396* Variables:: Program variables
4397* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4398* Output Formats:: Output formats
4399* Memory:: Examining memory
4400* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4401* Print Settings:: Print settings
4402* Value History:: Value history
4403* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4404* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4405* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4406* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4407* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
c906108c
SS
4408@end menu
4409
6d2ebf8b 4410@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4411@section Expressions
4412
4413@cindex expressions
4414@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4415compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4416by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4417@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4418and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4419by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4420
d4f3574e
SS
4421@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4422the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4423you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4424memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4425
c906108c
SS
4426Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4427this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4428Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4429languages.
4430
4431In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4432expressions regardless of your programming language.
4433
4434Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4435useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4436at that address in memory.
4437@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4438
4439@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4440to programming languages:
4441
4442@table @code
4443@item @@
4444@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4445@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4446
4447@item ::
4448@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4449function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4450
4451@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4452@cindex type casting memory
4453@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4454@cindex casts, to view memory
4455@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4456Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4457memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4458pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4459a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4460normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4461@end table
4462
6d2ebf8b 4463@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4464@section Program variables
4465
4466The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4467in your program.
4468
4469Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4470(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4471
4472@itemize @bullet
4473@item
4474global (or file-static)
4475@end itemize
4476
5d161b24 4477@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4478
4479@itemize @bullet
4480@item
4481visible according to the scope rules of the
4482programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4483@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4484
4485@noindent This means that in the function
4486
474c8240 4487@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4488foo (a)
4489 int a;
4490@{
4491 bar (a);
4492 @{
4493 int b = test ();
4494 bar (b);
4495 @}
4496@}
474c8240 4497@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4498
4499@noindent
4500you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4501executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4502examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4503the block where @code{b} is declared.
4504
4505@cindex variable name conflict
4506There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4507scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4508in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4509function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4510happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4511you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4512using the colon-colon notation:
4513
d4f3574e 4514@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4515@iftex
4516@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4517@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4518@end iftex
474c8240 4519@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4520@var{file}::@var{variable}
4521@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4522@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4523
4524@noindent
4525Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4526static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4527make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4528to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4529
474c8240 4530@smallexample
c906108c 4531(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4532@end smallexample
c906108c 4533
b37052ae 4534@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4535This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4536use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4537scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4538@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4539@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4540
4541@cindex wrong values
4542@cindex variable values, wrong
4543@quotation
4544@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4545wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4546scope, and just before exit.
4547@end quotation
4548You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4549This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4550set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4551stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4552values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4553also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4554after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4555variable definitions may be gone.
4556
4557This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4558To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4559when compiling.
4560
d4f3574e
SS
4561@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4562Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4563unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4564opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4565offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4566might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4567happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4568
474c8240 4569@smallexample
d4f3574e 4570No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4571@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4572
4573To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4574different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4575formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4576supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4577in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4578to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4579debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4580Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4581information.
4582
4583
6d2ebf8b 4584@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4585@section Artificial arrays
4586
4587@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4588@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4589It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4590same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4591dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4592program.
4593
4594You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4595@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4596operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4597and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4598of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4599the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4600argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4601following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4602example. If a program says
4603
474c8240 4604@smallexample
c906108c 4605int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4606@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4607
4608@noindent
4609you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4610
474c8240 4611@smallexample
c906108c 4612p *array@@len
474c8240 4613@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4614
4615The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4616with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4617subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4618Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4619(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4620
4621Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4622This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4623The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4624@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4625(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4626$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4627@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4628
4629As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4630@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4631the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4632@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4633(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4634$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4635@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4636
4637Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4638moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4639actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4640of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4641to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4642variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4643interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4644instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4645structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4646in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4647
474c8240 4648@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4649set $i = 0
4650p dtab[$i++]->fv
4651@key{RET}
4652@key{RET}
4653@dots{}
474c8240 4654@end smallexample
c906108c 4655
6d2ebf8b 4656@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4657@section Output formats
4658
4659@cindex formatted output
4660@cindex output formats
4661By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4662this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4663in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4664at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4665these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4666
4667The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4668already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4669@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4670letters supported are:
4671
4672@table @code
4673@item x
4674Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4675hexadecimal.
4676
4677@item d
4678Print as integer in signed decimal.
4679
4680@item u
4681Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4682
4683@item o
4684Print as integer in octal.
4685
4686@item t
4687Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4688@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4689used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4690see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4691
4692@item a
4693@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4694@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4695Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4696the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4697where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4698
474c8240 4699@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4700(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4701$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4702@end smallexample
c906108c 4703
3d67e040
EZ
4704@noindent
4705The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4706@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4707
c906108c
SS
4708@item c
4709Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4710
4711@item f
4712Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4713using typical floating point syntax.
4714@end table
4715
4716For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4717
474c8240 4718@smallexample
c906108c 4719p/x $pc
474c8240 4720@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4721
4722@noindent
4723Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4724names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4725
4726To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4727you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4728expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4729
6d2ebf8b 4730@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4731@section Examining memory
4732
4733You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4734any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4735
4736@cindex examining memory
4737@table @code
41afff9a 4738@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4739@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4740@itemx x @var{addr}
4741@itemx x
4742Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4743@end table
4744
4745@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4746much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4747expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4748If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4749Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4750
4751@table @r
4752@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4753The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4754how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4755@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4756@c 4.1.2.
4757
4758@item @var{f}, the display format
4759The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4760@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4761The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4762The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4763
4764@item @var{u}, the unit size
4765The unit size is any of
4766
4767@table @code
4768@item b
4769Bytes.
4770@item h
4771Halfwords (two bytes).
4772@item w
4773Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4774@item g
4775Giant words (eight bytes).
4776@end table
4777
4778Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4779default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4780@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4781
4782@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4783@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4784memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4785it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4786@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4787@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4788other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4789the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4790starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4791a value from memory).
4792@end table
4793
4794For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4795(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4796starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4797words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4798@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4799
4800Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4801letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4802unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4803specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4804(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4805
4806Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4807and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4808@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4809including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4810alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4811Code,,Source and machine code}.
4812
4813All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4814easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4815you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4816instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4817with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4818the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4819for successive uses of @code{x}.
4820
4821@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4822The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4823in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4824would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4825subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4826@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4827examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4828@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4829the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4830
4831If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4832are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4833address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4834
6d2ebf8b 4835@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4836@section Automatic display
4837@cindex automatic display
4838@cindex display of expressions
4839
4840If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4841(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4842display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4843Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4844to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4845The automatic display looks like this:
4846
474c8240 4847@smallexample
c906108c
SS
48482: foo = 38
48493: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4850@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4851
4852@noindent
4853This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4854displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4855specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4856whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4857format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4858or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4859supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4860
4861@table @code
4862@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4863@item display @var{expr}
4864Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4865each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4866
4867@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4868
d4f3574e 4869@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4870For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4871count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4872arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4873@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4874
4875@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4876For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4877number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4878be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4879doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4880@end table
4881
4882For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4883instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4884is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4885
4886@table @code
4887@kindex delete display
4888@kindex undisplay
4889@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4890@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4891Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4892
4893@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4894(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4895
4896@kindex disable display
4897@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4898Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4899item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4900enabled again later.
4901
4902@kindex enable display
4903@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4904Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4905again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4906
4907@item display
4908Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4909done when your program stops.
4910
4911@kindex info display
4912@item info display
4913Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4914automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4915values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4916It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4917because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4918@end table
4919
4920If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4921sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4922expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4923variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4924@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4925@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4926continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4927there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4928automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4929is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4930
6d2ebf8b 4931@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4932@section Print settings
4933
4934@cindex format options
4935@cindex print settings
4936@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4937and symbols are printed.
4938
4939@noindent
4940These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4941
4942@table @code
4943@kindex set print address
4944@item set print address
4945@itemx set print address on
4946@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4947traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4948even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4949is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4950@code{set print address on}:
4951
4952@smallexample
4953@group
4954(@value{GDBP}) f
4955#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4956 at input.c:530
4957530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4958@end group
4959@end smallexample
4960
4961@item set print address off
4962Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4963this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4964
4965@smallexample
4966@group
4967(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4968(@value{GDBP}) f
4969#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4970530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4971@end group
4972@end smallexample
4973
4974You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4975dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4976@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4977all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4978
4979@kindex show print address
4980@item show print address
4981Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4982@end table
4983
4984When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4985closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4986identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4987source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4988@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4989you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4990it prints a symbolic address:
4991
4992@table @code
4993@kindex set print symbol-filename
4994@item set print symbol-filename on
4995Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4996symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4997
4998@item set print symbol-filename off
4999Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5000default.
5001
5002@kindex show print symbol-filename
5003@item show print symbol-filename
5004Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5005line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5006@end table
5007
5008Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5009numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5010number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5011
5012Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5013printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5014
5015@table @code
5016@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5017@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5018Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5019offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5020@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5021to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5022
5023@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5024@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5025Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5026symbolic address.
5027@end table
5028
5029@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5030@cindex pointer, finding referent
5031If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5032@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5033and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5034@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5035For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5036at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5037
474c8240 5038@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5039(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5040(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5041$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5042@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5043
5044@quotation
5045@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5046does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5047the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5048@end quotation
5049
5050Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5051
5052@table @code
5053@kindex set print array
5054@item set print array
5055@itemx set print array on
5056Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5057but uses more space. The default is off.
5058
5059@item set print array off
5060Return to compressed format for arrays.
5061
5062@kindex show print array
5063@item show print array
5064Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5065arrays.
5066
5067@kindex set print elements
5068@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5069Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5070If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5071printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5072This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5073When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5074Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5075
5076@kindex show print elements
5077@item show print elements
5078Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5079If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5080
5081@kindex set print null-stop
5082@item set print null-stop
5083Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5084@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5085contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5086The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5087
5088@kindex set print pretty
5089@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5090Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5091per line, like this:
5092
5093@smallexample
5094@group
5095$1 = @{
5096 next = 0x0,
5097 flags = @{
5098 sweet = 1,
5099 sour = 1
5100 @},
5101 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5102@}
5103@end group
5104@end smallexample
5105
5106@item set print pretty off
5107Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5108
5109@smallexample
5110@group
5111$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5112meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5113@end group
5114@end smallexample
5115
5116@noindent
5117This is the default format.
5118
5119@kindex show print pretty
5120@item show print pretty
5121Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5122
5123@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5124@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5125Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5126@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5127character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5128best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5129high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5130
5131@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5132Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5133international character sets, and is the default.
5134
5135@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5136@item show print sevenbit-strings
5137Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5138
5139@kindex set print union
5140@item set print union on
5d161b24 5141Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5142is the default setting.
5143
5144@item set print union off
5145Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5146
5147@kindex show print union
5148@item show print union
5149Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5150structures.
5151
5152For example, given the declarations
5153
5154@smallexample
5155typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5156typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5157typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5158 Bug_forms;
5159
5160struct thing @{
5161 Species it;
5162 union @{
5163 Tree_forms tree;
5164 Bug_forms bug;
5165 @} form;
5166@};
5167
5168struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5169@end smallexample
5170
5171@noindent
5172with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5173
5174@smallexample
5175$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5176@end smallexample
5177
5178@noindent
5179and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5180
5181@smallexample
5182$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5183@end smallexample
5184@end table
5185
c906108c
SS
5186@need 1000
5187@noindent
b37052ae 5188These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5189
5190@table @code
5191@cindex demangling
5192@kindex set print demangle
5193@item set print demangle
5194@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5195Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5196(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5197linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5198
5199@kindex show print demangle
5200@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5201Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5202
5203@kindex set print asm-demangle
5204@item set print asm-demangle
5205@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5206Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5207in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5208The default is off.
5209
5210@kindex show print asm-demangle
5211@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5212Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5213or demangled form.
5214
5215@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5216@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5217@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5218@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5219Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5220represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5221
5222@table @code
5223@item auto
5224Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5225
5226@item gnu
b37052ae 5227Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5228This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5229
5230@item hp
b37052ae 5231Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5232
5233@item lucid
b37052ae 5234Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5235
5236@item arm
b37052ae 5237Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5238@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5239debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5240require further enhancement to permit that.
5241
5242@end table
5243If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5244
5245@kindex show demangle-style
5246@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5247Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5248
5249@kindex set print object
5250@item set print object
5251@itemx set print object on
5252When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5253(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5254the virtual function table.
5255
5256@item set print object off
5257Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5258virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5259
5260@kindex show print object
5261@item show print object
5262Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5263
5264@kindex set print static-members
5265@item set print static-members
5266@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5267Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5268
5269@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5270Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5271
5272@kindex show print static-members
5273@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5274Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5275
5276@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5277@kindex set print vtbl
5278@item set print vtbl
5279@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5280Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5281(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5282ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5283
5284@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5285Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5286
5287@kindex show print vtbl
5288@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5289Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5290@end table
c906108c 5291
6d2ebf8b 5292@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5293@section Value history
5294
5295@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5296Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5297@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5298Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5299(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5300When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5301since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5302symbol table.
5303
5304@cindex @code{$}
5305@cindex @code{$$}
5306@cindex history number
5307The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5308refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5309@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5310printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5311history number.
5312
5313To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5314history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5315remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5316the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5317@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5318is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5319@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5320
5321For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5322want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5323
474c8240 5324@smallexample
c906108c 5325p *$
474c8240 5326@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5327
5328If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5329to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5330
474c8240 5331@smallexample
c906108c 5332p *$.next
474c8240 5333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5334
5335@noindent
5336You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5337command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5338
5339Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5340@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5341
474c8240 5342@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5343print x
5344set x=5
474c8240 5345@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5346
5347@noindent
5348then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5349remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5350
5351@table @code
5352@kindex show values
5353@item show values
5354Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5355This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5356values} does not change the history.
5357
5358@item show values @var{n}
5359Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5360
5361@item show values +
5362Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5363values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5364@end table
5365
5366Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5367same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5368
6d2ebf8b 5369@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5370@section Convenience variables
5371
5372@cindex convenience variables
5373@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5374@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5375exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5376setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5377of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5378
5379Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5380@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5381the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5382(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5383by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5384
5385You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5386expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5387For example:
5388
474c8240 5389@smallexample
c906108c 5390set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5391@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5392
5393@noindent
5394would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5395@code{object_ptr}.
5396
5397Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5398value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5399value with another assignment at any time.
5400
5401Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5402variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5403that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5404variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5405
5406@table @code
5407@kindex show convenience
5408@item show convenience
5409Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5410Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5411@end table
5412
5413One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5414incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5415a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5416
474c8240 5417@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5418set $i = 0
5419print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5420@end smallexample
c906108c 5421
d4f3574e
SS
5422@noindent
5423Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5424
5425Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5426values likely to be useful.
5427
5428@table @code
41afff9a 5429@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5430@item $_
5431The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5432the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5433commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5434set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5435and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5436except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5437to the type of @code{$__}.
5438
41afff9a 5439@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5440@item $__
5441The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5442to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5443to match the format in which the data was printed.
5444
5445@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5446@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5447The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5448the program being debugged terminates.
5449@end table
5450
53a5351d
JM
5451On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5452begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5453name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5454
6d2ebf8b 5455@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5456@section Registers
5457
5458@cindex registers
5459You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5460with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5461for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5462your machine.
5463
5464@table @code
5465@kindex info registers
5466@item info registers
5467Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5468registers (in the selected stack frame).
5469
5470@kindex info all-registers
5471@cindex floating point registers
5472@item info all-registers
5473Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5474registers.
5475
5476@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5477Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5478As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5479the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5480the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5481@end table
5482
5483@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5484expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5485architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5486@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5487the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5488pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5489register that contains the processor status. For example,
5490you could print the program counter in hex with
5491
474c8240 5492@smallexample
c906108c 5493p/x $pc
474c8240 5494@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5495
5496@noindent
5497or print the instruction to be executed next with
5498
474c8240 5499@smallexample
c906108c 5500x/i $pc
474c8240 5501@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5502
5503@noindent
5504or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5505one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5506memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5507stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5508stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5509regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5510see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5511
474c8240 5512@smallexample
c906108c 5513set $sp += 4
474c8240 5514@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5515
5516Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5517your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5518so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5519shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5520registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5521can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5522is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5523
5524@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5525integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5526special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5527registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5528to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5529(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5530@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5531
5532Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5533means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5534the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5535sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5536coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5537programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5538cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5539that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5540prints the data in both formats.
5541
5542Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5543(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5544value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5545were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5546true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5547frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5548
5549However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5550code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5551@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5552frame makes no difference.
5553
6d2ebf8b 5554@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5555@section Floating point hardware
5556@cindex floating point
5557
5558Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5559you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5560
5561@table @code
5562@kindex info float
5563@item info float
5564Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5565point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5566floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5567the ARM and x86 machines.
5568@end table
c906108c 5569
29e57380 5570@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5571@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5572@cindex memory region attributes
5573
5574@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5575required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5576to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5577use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5578
5579Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5580memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5581accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5582been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5583all memory.
5584
5585When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5586to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5587
5588@table @code
5589@kindex mem
59649f2e 5590@item mem @var{address1} @var{address2} @var{attributes}@dots{}
29e57380
C
5591Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5592with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5593
5594@kindex delete mem
5595@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5596Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5597
5598@kindex disable mem
5599@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5600Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5601A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5602It may be enabled again later.
5603
5604@kindex enable mem
5605@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5606Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5607
5608@kindex info mem
5609@item info mem
5610Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5611for each region.
5612
5613@table @emph
5614@item Memory Region Number
5615@item Enabled or Disabled.
5616Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5617Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5618
5619@item Lo Address
5620The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5621
5622@item Hi Address
5623The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5624
5625@item Attributes
5626The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5627@end table
5628@end table
5629
5630
5631@subsection Attributes
5632
5633@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5634The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5635write accesses to a memory region.
5636
5637While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5638memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5639etc. from accessing memory.
5640
5641@table @code
5642@item ro
5643Memory is read only.
5644@item wo
5645Memory is write only.
5646@item rw
6ca652b0 5647Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5648@end table
5649
5650@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5651The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5652accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5653require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5654specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5655
5656@table @code
5657@item 8
5658Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5659@item 16
5660Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5661@item 32
5662Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5663@item 64
5664Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5665@end table
5666
5667@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5668@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5669@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5670@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5671@c
5672@c @table @code
5673@c @item hwbreak
5674@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5675@c @item swbreak (default)
5676@c @end table
5677
5678@subsubsection Data Cache
5679The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5680memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5681protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5682does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5683registers.
5684
5685@table @code
5686@item cache
5687Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5688@item nocache
5689Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5690@end table
5691
5692@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5693@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5694@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5695@c
5696@c @table @code
5697@c @item verify
5698@c @item noverify (default)
5699@c @end table
5700
16d9dec6
MS
5701@node Dump/Restore Files
5702@section Copy between memory and a file
5703@cindex dump/restore files
5704@cindex append data to a file
5705@cindex dump data to a file
5706@cindex restore data from a file
5707@kindex dump
5708@kindex append
5709@kindex restore
5710
5711The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5712for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5713into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5714file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5715intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5716
5717@table @code
5718@kindex dump binary
5719@kindex append binary
5720@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5721Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5722raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5723
5724@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5725Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5726raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5727
5728@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5729Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5730
5731@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5732Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5733
5734@kindex dump ihex
5735@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5736Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5737intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5738
5739@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5740Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5741
5742@kindex dump srec
5743@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5744Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5745srec format file @var{filename}.
5746
5747@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5748Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5749
5750@kindex dump tekhex
5751@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5752Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5753tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5754
5755@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5756Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5757
5758@item restore @var{filename} @var{[binary]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5759Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5760command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5761raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5762@var{binary} after the filename.
5763
5764If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5765contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5766they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5767a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5768from that location.
5769
5770If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5771file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5772These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5773the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5774
5775@end table
5776
b37052ae
EZ
5777@node Tracepoints
5778@chapter Tracepoints
5779@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5780@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5781
5782@cindex tracepoints
5783In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5784the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5785anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5786depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5787might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5788fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5789to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5790
5791Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5792specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5793arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5794Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5795those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5796expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5797for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5798a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5799in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5800values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5801unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5802
5803The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
5804targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
5805to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
5806stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
5807tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
5808
5809This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5810
5811@menu
5812* Set Tracepoints::
5813* Analyze Collected Data::
5814* Tracepoint Variables::
5815@end menu
5816
5817@node Set Tracepoints
5818@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5819
5820Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5821tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5822tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5823breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5824one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5825tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5826work on.
5827
5828For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5829of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5830it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5831local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5832commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5833tracepoint was hit.
5834
5835This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5836conditions and actions.
5837
5838@menu
5839* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5840* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5841* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5842* Tracepoint Actions::
5843* Listing Tracepoints::
5844* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5845@end menu
5846
5847@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5848@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5849
5850@table @code
5851@cindex set tracepoint
5852@kindex trace
5853@item trace
5854The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5855Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5856the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5857defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5858debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5859program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5860doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5861cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5862running.
5863
5864Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5865
5866@smallexample
5867(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5868
5869(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5870
5871(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5872
5873(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5874
5875(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5876@end smallexample
5877
5878@noindent
5879You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5880
5881@vindex $tpnum
5882@cindex last tracepoint number
5883@cindex recent tracepoint number
5884@cindex tracepoint number
5885The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5886of the most recently set tracepoint.
5887
5888@kindex delete tracepoint
5889@cindex tracepoint deletion
5890@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5891Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5892default is to delete all tracepoints.
5893
5894Examples:
5895
5896@smallexample
5897(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5898
5899(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5900@end smallexample
5901
5902@noindent
5903You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5904@end table
5905
5906@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5907@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5908
5909@table @code
5910@kindex disable tracepoint
5911@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5912Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5913@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5914the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5915a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5916
5917@kindex enable tracepoint
5918@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5919Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5920tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5921run.
5922@end table
5923
5924@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5925@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5926
5927@table @code
5928@kindex passcount
5929@cindex tracepoint pass count
5930@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5931Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5932automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5933@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5934the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5935@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5936passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5937given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5938user.
5939
5940Examples:
5941
5942@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
5943(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
5944@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
5945
5946(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 5947@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
5948(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5949(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5950(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5951(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5952(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5953(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
5954@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
5955@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
5956@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
5957@end smallexample
5958@end table
5959
5960@node Tracepoint Actions
5961@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5962
5963@table @code
5964@kindex actions
5965@cindex tracepoint actions
5966@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5967This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5968tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5969specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5970recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5971@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5972actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5973terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5974far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5975@code{while-stepping}.
5976
5977@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5978To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5979and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5980
5981@smallexample
5982(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5983
6826cf00 5984(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 5985
6826cf00 5986(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
5987@end smallexample
5988
5989In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5990commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5991hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5992following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5993followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5994@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5995@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5996@code{end} command.
5997
5998@smallexample
5999(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6000(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6001Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6002> collect bar,baz
6003> collect $regs
6004> while-stepping 12
6005 > collect $fp, $sp
6006 > end
6007end
6008@end smallexample
6009
6010@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6011@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6012Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6013This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6014In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6015special arguments are supported:
6016
6017@table @code
6018@item $regs
6019collect all registers
6020
6021@item $args
6022collect all function arguments
6023
6024@item $locals
6025collect all local variables.
6026@end table
6027
6028You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6029with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6030arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6031
f5c37c66
EZ
6032The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6033particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6034
b37052ae
EZ
6035@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6036@item while-stepping @var{n}
6037Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6038new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6039followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6040its own @code{end} command):
6041
6042@smallexample
6043> while-stepping 12
6044 > collect $regs, myglobal
6045 > end
6046>
6047@end smallexample
6048
6049@noindent
6050You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6051@code{stepping}.
6052@end table
6053
6054@node Listing Tracepoints
6055@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6056
6057@table @code
6058@kindex info tracepoints
6059@cindex information about tracepoints
6060@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6061Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6062a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6063defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6064shown:
6065
6066@itemize @bullet
6067@item
6068its number
6069@item
6070whether it is enabled or disabled
6071@item
6072its address
6073@item
6074its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6075@item
6076its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6077@item
6078where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6079@item
6080its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6081@end itemize
6082
6083@smallexample
6084(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6085Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
60861 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
60872 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
60883 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6089(@value{GDBP})
6090@end smallexample
6091
6092@noindent
6093This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6094@end table
6095
6096@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6097@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6098
6099@table @code
6100@kindex tstart
6101@cindex start a new trace experiment
6102@cindex collected data discarded
6103@item tstart
6104This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6105begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6106the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6107experiment.
6108
6109@kindex tstop
6110@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6111@item tstop
6112This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6113stops collecting data.
6114
6115@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6116automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6117(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6118
6119@kindex tstatus
6120@cindex status of trace data collection
6121@cindex trace experiment, status of
6122@item tstatus
6123This command displays the status of the current trace data
6124collection.
6125@end table
6126
6127Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6128
6129@smallexample
6130(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6131(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6132Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6133> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6134> while-stepping 11
6135 > collect $regs
6136 > end
6137> end
6138(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6139 [time passes @dots{}]
6140(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6141@end smallexample
6142
6143
6144@node Analyze Collected Data
6145@section Using the collected data
6146
6147After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6148for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6149collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6150snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6151consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6152examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6153specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6154snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6155registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6156rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6157debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6158(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6159behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6160when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6161the buffer will fail.
6162
6163@menu
6164* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6165* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6166* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6167@end menu
6168
6169@node tfind
6170@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6171
6172@kindex tfind
6173@cindex select trace snapshot
6174@cindex find trace snapshot
6175The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6176@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6177counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6178snapshot is selected.
6179
6180Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6181
6182@table @code
6183@item tfind start
6184Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6185@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6186
6187@item tfind none
6188Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6189
6190@item tfind end
6191Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6192
6193@item tfind
6194No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6195
6196@item tfind -
6197Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6198retracing earlier steps.
6199
6200@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6201Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6202proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6203argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6204for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6205
6206@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6207Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6208program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6209snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6210snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6211
6212@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6213Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6214addresses.
6215
6216@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6217Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6218@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6219
6220@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6221Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6222the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6223that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6224trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6225next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6226@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6227stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6228@end table
6229
6230The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6231designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6232instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6233snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6234trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6235simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6236snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6237@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6238The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6239for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6240no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6241(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6242no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6243tracepoint as the current one.
6244
6245In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6246these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6247scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6248you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6249registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6250
6251@smallexample
6252(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6253(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6254> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6255 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6256> tfind
6257> end
6258
6259Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6260Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6261Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6262Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6263Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6264Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6265Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6266Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6267Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6268Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6269Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6270@end smallexample
6271
6272Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6273the buffer:
6274
6275@smallexample
6276(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6277(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6278> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6279> tfind line
6280> end
6281
6282Frame 0, X = 1
6283Frame 7, X = 2
6284Frame 13, X = 255
6285@end smallexample
6286
6287@node tdump
6288@subsection @code{tdump}
6289@kindex tdump
6290@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6291@cindex tracepoint data, display
6292
6293This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6294the current trace snapshot.
6295
6296@smallexample
6297(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6298(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6299Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6300> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6301> end
6302
6303(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6304
6305(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6306#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6307at gdb_test.c:444
6308444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6309
6310(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6311Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6312d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6313d1 0x18 24
6314d2 0x80 128
6315d3 0x33 51
6316d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6317d5 0x22 34
6318d6 0xe0 224
6319d7 0x380035 3670069
6320a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6321a1 0x3000668 50333288
6322a2 0x100 256
6323a3 0x322000 3284992
6324a4 0x3000698 50333336
6325a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6326fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6327sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6328ps 0x0 0
6329pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6330fpcontrol 0x0 0
6331fpstatus 0x0 0
6332fpiaddr 0x0 0
6333p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6334p1 = (void *) 0x11
6335p2 = (void *) 0x22
6336p3 = (void *) 0x33
6337p4 = (void *) 0x44
6338p5 = (void *) 0x55
6339p6 = (void *) 0x66
6340gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6341
6342(@value{GDBP})
6343@end smallexample
6344
6345@node save-tracepoints
6346@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6347@kindex save-tracepoints
6348@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6349
6350This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6351their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6352suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6353tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6354Files}).
6355
6356@node Tracepoint Variables
6357@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6358@cindex tracepoint variables
6359@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6360
6361@table @code
6362@vindex $trace_frame
6363@item (int) $trace_frame
6364The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6365snapshot is selected.
6366
6367@vindex $tracepoint
6368@item (int) $tracepoint
6369The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6370
6371@vindex $trace_line
6372@item (int) $trace_line
6373The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6374
6375@vindex $trace_file
6376@item (char []) $trace_file
6377The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6378
6379@vindex $trace_func
6380@item (char []) $trace_func
6381The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6382@end table
6383
6384Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6385use @code{output} instead.
6386
6387Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6388stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6389data.
6390
6391@smallexample
6392(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6393
6394(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6395> output $trace_file
6396> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6397> tfind
6398> end
6399@end smallexample
6400
df0cd8c5
JB
6401@node Overlays
6402@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6403@cindex overlays
6404
6405If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6406memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6407problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6408use overlays.
6409
6410@menu
6411* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6412* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6413* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6414 mapped by asking the inferior.
6415* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6416@end menu
6417
6418@node How Overlays Work
6419@section How Overlays Work
6420@cindex mapped overlays
6421@cindex unmapped overlays
6422@cindex load address, overlay's
6423@cindex mapped address
6424@cindex overlay area
6425
6426Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6427kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6428other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6429management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6430adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6431
6432One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6433independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6434@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6435their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6436instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6437largest overlay as well.
6438
6439Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6440overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6441for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6442there.
6443
c928edc0
AC
6444@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
6445@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
6446@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
6447
474c8240 6448@smallexample
df0cd8c5 6449@group
c928edc0
AC
6450 Data Instruction Larger
6451Address Space Address Space Address Space
6452+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6453| | | | | |
6454+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6455| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
6456| variables | | program | | +-----------+
6457| and heap | | | | | |
6458+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6459| | +-----------+ | | | load address
6460+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
6461 | | | | | |
6462 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
6463 address | | | | | |
6464 | overlay | <-' | | |
6465 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6466 | | <---. | | load address
6467 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
6468 | | | |
6469 +-----------+ | |
6470 +-----------+
6471 | |
6472 +-----------+
6473
6474 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 6475@end group
474c8240 6476@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 6477
c928edc0
AC
6478The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
6479and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
6480its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
6481Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
6482may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
6483data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
6484program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
6485program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
6486
6487An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6488@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6489instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6490in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6491is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6492the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6493called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6494
6495Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6496program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6497global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6498
6499@itemize @bullet
6500
6501@item
6502Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6503must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6504return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6505overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6506
6507@item
6508If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6509will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6510your program's performance.
6511
6512@item
6513The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6514overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6515mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6516and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6517You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6518addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6519ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6520
6521@item
6522The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6523to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6524instruction and data spaces.
6525
6526@end itemize
6527
6528The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6529improved in many ways:
6530
6531@itemize @bullet
6532
6533@item
6534If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6535hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6536contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6537This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6538area in the usual way.
6539
6540@item
6541If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6542overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6543
6544@item
6545You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6546general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6547code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6548return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6549the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6550must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6551different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6552
6553@end itemize
6554
6555
6556@node Overlay Commands
6557@section Overlay Commands
6558
6559To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6560correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6561virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6562mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6563@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6564variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6565
6566@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6567you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6568
6569@table @code
6570@item overlay off
6571@kindex overlay off
6572Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6573disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6574always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6575overlay support is disabled.
6576
6577@item overlay manual
6578@kindex overlay manual
6579@cindex manual overlay debugging
6580Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6581relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6582using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6583commands described below.
6584
6585@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6586@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6587@kindex overlay map-overlay
6588@cindex map an overlay
6589Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6590be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6591overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6592functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6593that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6594@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6595
6596@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6597@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6598@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6599@cindex unmap an overlay
6600Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6601must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6602When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6603overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6604
6605@item overlay auto
6606@kindex overlay auto
6607Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6608consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6609to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6610Overlay Debugging}.
6611
6612@item overlay load-target
6613@itemx overlay load
6614@kindex overlay load-target
6615@cindex reloading the overlay table
6616Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6617re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6618stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6619overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6620useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6621
6622@item overlay list-overlays
6623@itemx overlay list
6624@cindex listing mapped overlays
6625Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6626addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6627
6628@end table
6629
6630Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6631of the function the address falls in:
6632
474c8240 6633@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6634(gdb) print main
6635$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 6636@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6637@noindent
6638When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6639unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6640asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6641unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6642
474c8240 6643@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6644(gdb) overlay list
6645No sections are mapped.
6646(gdb) print foo
6647$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 6648@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6649@noindent
6650When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6651name normally:
6652
474c8240 6653@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6654(gdb) overlay list
6655Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6656 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6657(gdb) print foo
6658$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 6659@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6660
6661When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6662address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6663overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6664@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6665code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6666
6667@itemize @bullet
6668@item
6669@cindex breakpoints in overlays
6670@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6671You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6672@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6673@item
6674@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6675unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6676overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6677you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6678breakpoints properly.
6679@end itemize
6680
6681
6682@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6683@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6684@cindex automatic overlay debugging
6685
6686@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6687are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6688inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6689@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6690looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6691current state of the overlays.
6692
6693Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6694@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6695
6696@table @asis
6697
6698@item @code{_ovly_table}:
6699This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6700
474c8240 6701@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6702struct
6703@{
6704 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6705 unsigned long vma;
6706
6707 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6708 unsigned long size;
6709
6710 /* The overlay's load address. */
6711 unsigned long lma;
6712
6713 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6714 zero otherwise. */
6715 unsigned long mapped;
6716@}
474c8240 6717@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6718
6719@item @code{_novlys}:
6720This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6721number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6722
6723@end table
6724
6725To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6726looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6727@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6728executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6729the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6730currently mapped.
6731
81d46470 6732In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 6733@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
6734will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
6735calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
6736will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
6737are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
6738in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
6739overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
6740are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
6741
6742@node Overlay Sample Program
6743@section Overlay Sample Program
6744@cindex overlay example program
6745
6746When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6747at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6748addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6749Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6750since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6751architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6752portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6753
6754However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6755program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6756suite. The program consists of the following files from
6757@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
6758
6759@table @file
6760@item overlays.c
6761The main program file.
6762@item ovlymgr.c
6763A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
6764@item foo.c
6765@itemx bar.c
6766@itemx baz.c
6767@itemx grbx.c
6768Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
6769@item d10v.ld
6770@itemx m32r.ld
6771Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
6772and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
6773@end table
6774
6775You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
6776cross-compiler like this:
6777
474c8240 6778@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6779$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
6780$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
6781$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
6782$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
6783$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
6784$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
6785$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
6786 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 6787@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6788
6789The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
6790you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
6791target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
6792
6793
6d2ebf8b 6794@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6795@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6796@cindex languages
6797
c906108c
SS
6798Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6799rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6800dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6801Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6802represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6803@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6804
6805@cindex working language
6806Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6807allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6808native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6809consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6810language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6811language}.
6812
6813@menu
6814* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6815* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6816* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6817* Support:: Supported languages
6818@end menu
6819
6d2ebf8b 6820@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6821@section Switching between source languages
6822
6823There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6824set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6825@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6826defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6827used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6828are printed, etc.
6829
6830In addition to the working language, every source file that
6831@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6832file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6833source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6834language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6835controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6836show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6837set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6838set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6839Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6840
6841This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6842as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6843another language. In that case, make the
6844program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6845@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6846program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6847
6848@menu
6849* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6850* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6851* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6852@end menu
6853
6d2ebf8b 6854@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6855@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6856
6857If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6858@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6859
6860@table @file
6861
6862@item .c
6863C source file
6864
6865@item .C
6866@itemx .cc
6867@itemx .cp
6868@itemx .cpp
6869@itemx .cxx
6870@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6871C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6872
6873@item .f
6874@itemx .F
6875Fortran source file
6876
c906108c
SS
6877@item .ch
6878@itemx .c186
6879@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6880CHILL source file
c906108c 6881
c906108c
SS
6882@item .mod
6883Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6884
6885@item .s
6886@itemx .S
6887Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6888@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6889@end table
6890
6891In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6892extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6893
6d2ebf8b 6894@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6895@subsection Setting the working language
6896
6897If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6898expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6899your program.
6900
6901@kindex set language
6902If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6903command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6904a language, such as
c906108c 6905@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6906For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6907
c906108c
SS
6908Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6909language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6910to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6911source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6912languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6913source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6914command such as:
6915
474c8240 6916@smallexample
c906108c 6917print a = b + c
474c8240 6918@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
6919
6920@noindent
6921might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6922@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6923printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6924@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6925
6d2ebf8b 6926@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6927@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6928
6929To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6930@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6931then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6932frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6933working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6934frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6935or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6936does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6937not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6938
6939This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6940entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6941written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6942a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6943case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6944
6d2ebf8b 6945@node Show
c906108c 6946@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6947
6948The following commands help you find out which language is the
6949working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6950
6951@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6952@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6953@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6954@table @code
6955@item show language
6956Display the current working language. This is the
6957language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6958build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6959
6960@item info frame
5d161b24 6961Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6962working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6963@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6964information listed here.
6965
6966@item info source
6967Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6968@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6969information listed here.
6970@end table
6971
6972In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6973not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6974with a language explicitly:
6975
6976@kindex set extension-language
6977@kindex info extensions
6978@table @code
6979@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6980Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6981the source language @var{language}.
6982
6983@item info extensions
6984List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6985@end table
6986
6d2ebf8b 6987@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6988@section Type and range checking
6989
6990@quotation
6991@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6992checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6993section documents the intended facilities.
6994@end quotation
6995@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6996
6997Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6998errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6999checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7000sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7001these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7002by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7003errors when your program is running.
7004
7005@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7006Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7007can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7008the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7009@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7010your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7011for the default settings of supported languages.
7012
7013@menu
7014* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7015* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7016@end menu
7017
7018@cindex type checking
7019@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7020@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7021@subsection An overview of type checking
7022
7023Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7024arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7025otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7026errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7027
7028@smallexample
70291 + 2 @result{} 3
7030@exdent but
7031@error{} 1 + 2.3
7032@end smallexample
7033
7034The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7035type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7036
5d161b24
DB
7037For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7038@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7039to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7040or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7041but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7042these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7043also issues a warning.
7044
5d161b24
DB
7045Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7046related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7047For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7048a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7049with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7050the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7051
7052Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7053instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7054operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7055represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7056operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7057details on specific languages.
7058
7059@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7060
d4f3574e 7061@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7062@kindex set check type
7063@kindex show check type
7064@table @code
7065@item set check type auto
7066Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7067@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7068each language.
7069
7070@item set check type on
7071@itemx set check type off
7072Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7073current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7074match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7075evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7076message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7077
7078@item set check type warn
7079Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7080evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7081be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7082numbers and structures.
7083
7084@item show type
5d161b24 7085Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7086is setting it automatically.
7087@end table
7088
7089@cindex range checking
7090@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7091@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7092@subsection An overview of range checking
7093
7094In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7095bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7096checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7097computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7098not exceed the bounds of the array.
7099
7100For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7101@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7102always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7103warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7104
7105A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7106array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7107of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7108error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7109result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7110the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7111
474c8240 7112@smallexample
c906108c 7113@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7114@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7115
7116This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7117specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7118Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7119
7120@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7121
d4f3574e 7122@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7123@kindex set check range
7124@kindex show check range
7125@table @code
7126@item set check range auto
7127Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7128@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7129each language.
7130
7131@item set check range on
7132@itemx set check range off
7133Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7134current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7135match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7136then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7137
7138@item set check range warn
7139Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7140but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7141expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7142memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7143systems).
7144
7145@item show range
7146Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7147being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7148@end table
c906108c 7149
6d2ebf8b 7150@node Support
c906108c 7151@section Supported languages
c906108c 7152
b37052ae 7153@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7154@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7155Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7156language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7157and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7158,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7159language.
7160
7161The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7162supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7163tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7164@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7165formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7166books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7167language reference or tutorial.
7168
c906108c 7169@menu
b37052ae 7170* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7171* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 7172* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7173@end menu
7174
6d2ebf8b 7175@node C
b37052ae 7176@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7177
b37052ae
EZ
7178@cindex C and C@t{++}
7179@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7180
b37052ae 7181Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7182to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7183together.
7184
41afff9a
EZ
7185@cindex C@t{++}
7186@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7187@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7188The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7189compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7190effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7191C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7192compiler (@code{aCC}).
7193
b37052ae 7194For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7195format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7196command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7197@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7198CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7199
c906108c 7200@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7201* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7202* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7203* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7204* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7205* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7206* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7207* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7208@end menu
c906108c 7209
6d2ebf8b 7210@node C Operators
b37052ae 7211@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7212
b37052ae 7213@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7214
7215Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7216@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7217often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7218
b37052ae 7219For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7220
7221@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7222
c906108c 7223@item
c906108c 7224@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7225specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7226
7227@item
d4f3574e
SS
7228@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7229@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7230
7231@item
53a5351d 7232@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7233
7234@item
7235@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7236
c906108c
SS
7237@end itemize
7238
7239@noindent
7240The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7241in order of increasing precedence:
7242
7243@table @code
7244@item ,
7245The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7246are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7247expression being the last expression evaluated.
7248
7249@item =
7250Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7251assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7252
7253@item @var{op}=
7254Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7255and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7256@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7257@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7258@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7259
7260@item ?:
7261The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7262of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7263integral type.
7264
7265@item ||
7266Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7267
7268@item &&
7269Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7270
7271@item |
7272Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7273
7274@item ^
7275Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7276
7277@item &
7278Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7279
7280@item ==@r{, }!=
7281Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7282expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7283
7284@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7285Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7286Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7287and non-zero for true.
7288
7289@item <<@r{, }>>
7290left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7291
7292@item @@
7293The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7294
7295@item +@r{, }-
7296Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7297pointer types.
7298
7299@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7300Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7301defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7302integral types.
7303
7304@item ++@r{, }--
7305Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7306operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7307when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7308operation takes place.
7309
7310@item *
7311Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7312@code{++}.
7313
7314@item &
7315Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7316
b37052ae
EZ
7317For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7318allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7319(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7320where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7321stored.
c906108c
SS
7322
7323@item -
7324Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7325precedence as @code{++}.
7326
7327@item !
7328Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7329@code{++}.
7330
7331@item ~
7332Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7333@code{++}.
7334
7335
7336@item .@r{, }->
7337Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7338@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7339pointer based on the stored type information.
7340Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7341
c906108c
SS
7342@item .*@r{, }->*
7343Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7344
7345@item []
7346Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7347@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7348
7349@item ()
7350Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7351
c906108c 7352@item ::
b37052ae 7353C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7354and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7355
7356@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7357Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7358(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7359above.
c906108c
SS
7360@end table
7361
c906108c
SS
7362If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7363attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7364predefined meaning.
c906108c 7365
c906108c 7366@menu
5d161b24 7367* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7368@end menu
7369
6d2ebf8b 7370@node C Constants
b37052ae 7371@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7372
b37052ae 7373@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7374
b37052ae 7375@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7376following ways:
c906108c
SS
7377
7378@itemize @bullet
7379@item
7380Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7381specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7382by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7383@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7384@code{long} value.
7385
7386@item
7387Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7388point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7389exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7390@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7391sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7392A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7393@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7394the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7395a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7396constant.
c906108c
SS
7397
7398@item
7399Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7400integral equivalents.
7401
7402@item
7403Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7404(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7405(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7406be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7407the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7408of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7409@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7410@samp{\n} for newline.
7411
7412@item
96a2c332
SS
7413String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7414double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7415above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7416a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7417characters.
c906108c
SS
7418
7419@item
7420Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7421to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7422
7423@item
7424Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7425and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7426integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7427and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7428@end itemize
7429
c906108c 7430@menu
5d161b24
DB
7431* C plus plus expressions::
7432* C Defaults::
7433* C Checks::
c906108c 7434
5d161b24 7435* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
7436@end menu
7437
6d2ebf8b 7438@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
7439@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7440
7441@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7442@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7443
7444@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7445@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7446@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7447@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7448@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7449@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7450@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7451@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7452@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7453@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7454@c periodically whether this has happened...
7455@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
7456@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7457proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
7458additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7459special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7460@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7461symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7462you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7463extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 7464@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7465support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7466@end quotation
c906108c
SS
7467
7468@enumerate
7469
7470@cindex member functions
7471@item
7472Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7473
474c8240 7474@smallexample
c906108c 7475count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 7476@end smallexample
c906108c 7477
41afff9a 7478@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 7479@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7480@item
7481While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7482expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7483that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 7484pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 7485
c906108c 7486@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 7487@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 7488@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7489@item
7490You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 7491call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
7492perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7493calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7494in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7495default arguments.
7496
7497It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7498promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7499class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7500functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7501number of function arguments.
7502
7503Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7504@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7505,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7506
d4f3574e 7507You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7508explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7509@smallexample
7510p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7511@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7512
c906108c 7513The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7514see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7515
c906108c
SS
7516@cindex reference declarations
7517@item
b37052ae
EZ
7518@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7519them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7520dereferenced.
7521
7522In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7523reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7524avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7525The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7526you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7527
7528@item
b37052ae 7529@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7530expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7531one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7532necessary, for example in an expression like
7533@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7534resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7535debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7536@end enumerate
7537
b37052ae 7538In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7539calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7540objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7541invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7542
6d2ebf8b 7543@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7544@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7545
b37052ae 7546@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7547
c906108c
SS
7548If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7549both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7550C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7551selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7552
7553If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7554recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7555@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7556these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7557@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7558for further details.
7559
c906108c
SS
7560@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7561@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7562@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7563
6d2ebf8b 7564@node C Checks
b37052ae 7565@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7566
b37052ae 7567@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7568
b37052ae 7569By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7570is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7571considers two variables type equivalent if:
7572
7573@itemize @bullet
7574@item
7575The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7576enumerated tag.
7577
7578@item
7579The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7580declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7581
7582@ignore
7583@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7584@c FIXME--beers?
7585@item
7586The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7587declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7588compilers.)
7589@end ignore
7590@end itemize
7591
7592Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7593indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7594that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7595
6d2ebf8b 7596@node Debugging C
c906108c 7597@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7598
7599The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7600the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7601inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7602appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7603
7604The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7605with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7606,Expressions}.
7607
c906108c 7608@menu
5d161b24 7609* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7610@end menu
7611
6d2ebf8b 7612@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7613@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7614
b37052ae 7615@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7616
b37052ae
EZ
7617Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7618designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7619
7620@table @code
7621@cindex break in overloaded functions
7622@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7623When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7624@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7625you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7626
b37052ae 7627@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7628@item rbreak @var{regex}
7629Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7630breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7631classes.
7632@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7633
b37052ae 7634@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7635@item catch throw
7636@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7637Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7638Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7639
7640@cindex inheritance
7641@item ptype @var{typename}
7642Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7643@var{typename}.
7644@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7645
b37052ae 7646@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7647@item set print demangle
7648@itemx show print demangle
7649@itemx set print asm-demangle
7650@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7651Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7652displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7653@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7654
7655@item set print object
7656@itemx show print object
7657Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7658@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7659
7660@item set print vtbl
7661@itemx show print vtbl
7662Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7663@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7664(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7665ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7666
7667@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7668@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7669@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7670Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7671is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7672and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7673using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7674expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7675message.
7676
7677@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7678Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7679overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7680chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7681symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7682overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7683searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7684argument types.
c906108c
SS
7685
7686@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7687You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7688the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7689@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7690also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7691available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7692@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7693@end table
c906108c 7694
6d2ebf8b 7695@node Modula-2
c906108c 7696@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7697
d4f3574e 7698@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7699
7700The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7701output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7702developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7703attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7704to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7705table.
7706
7707@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7708@menu
7709* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7710* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7711* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7712* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7713* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7714* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7715* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7716* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7717@end menu
7718
6d2ebf8b 7719@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7720@subsubsection Operators
7721@cindex Modula-2 operators
7722
7723Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7724@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7725often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7726following definitions hold:
7727
7728@itemize @bullet
7729
7730@item
7731@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7732their subranges.
7733
7734@item
7735@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7736
7737@item
7738@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7739
7740@item
7741@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7742@var{type}}.
7743
7744@item
7745@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7746
7747@item
7748@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7749
7750@item
7751@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7752@end itemize
7753
7754@noindent
7755The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7756increasing precedence:
7757
7758@table @code
7759@item ,
7760Function argument or array index separator.
7761
7762@item :=
7763Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7764@var{value}.
7765
7766@item <@r{, }>
7767Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7768types.
7769
7770@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7771Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7772on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7773set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7774
7775@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7776Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7777Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7778available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7779comment character.
7780
7781@item IN
7782Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7783Same precedence as @code{<}.
7784
7785@item OR
7786Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7787
7788@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7789Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7790
7791@item @@
7792The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7793
7794@item +@r{, }-
7795Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7796and difference on set types.
7797
7798@item *
7799Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7800on set types.
7801
7802@item /
7803Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7804types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7805
7806@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7807Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7808precedence as @code{*}.
7809
7810@item -
7811Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7812
7813@item ^
7814Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7815
7816@item NOT
7817Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7818@code{^}.
7819
7820@item .
7821@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7822precedence as @code{^}.
7823
7824@item []
7825Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7826
7827@item ()
7828Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7829as @code{^}.
7830
7831@item ::@r{, }.
7832@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7833@end table
7834
7835@quotation
7836@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7837treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7838@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7839@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7840@end quotation
7841
cb51c4e0 7842
6d2ebf8b 7843@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7844@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7845@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7846
7847Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7848In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7849
7850@table @var
7851
7852@item a
7853represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7854
7855@item c
7856represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7857
7858@item i
7859represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7860
7861@item m
7862represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7863same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7864be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7865
7866@item n
7867represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7868
7869@item r
7870represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7871
7872@item t
7873represents a type.
7874
7875@item v
7876represents a variable.
7877
7878@item x
7879represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7880explanation of the function for details.
7881@end table
7882
7883All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7884
7885@table @code
7886@item ABS(@var{n})
7887Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7888
7889@item CAP(@var{c})
7890If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7891equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7892
7893@item CHR(@var{i})
7894Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7895
7896@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7897Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7898
7899@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7900Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7901new value.
7902
7903@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7904Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7905set.
7906
7907@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7908Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7909
7910@item HIGH(@var{a})
7911Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7912
7913@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7914Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7915
7916@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7917Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7918new value.
7919
7920@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7921Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7922there. Returns the new set.
7923
7924@item MAX(@var{t})
7925Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7926
7927@item MIN(@var{t})
7928Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7929
7930@item ODD(@var{i})
7931Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7932
7933@item ORD(@var{x})
7934Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7935value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7936@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7937integral, character and enumerated types.
7938
7939@item SIZE(@var{x})
7940Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7941
7942@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7943Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7944
7945@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7946Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7947@end table
7948
7949@quotation
7950@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7951@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7952an error.
7953@end quotation
7954
7955@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7956@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7957@subsubsection Constants
7958
7959@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7960ways:
7961
7962@itemize @bullet
7963
7964@item
7965Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7966expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7967rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7968trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7969
7970@item
7971Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7972decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7973then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7974@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7975digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7976digits.
7977
7978@item
7979Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7980like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7981also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7982followed by a @samp{C}.
7983
7984@item
7985String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7986pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7987Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7988Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7989sequences.
7990
7991@item
7992Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7993
7994@item
7995Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7996@code{FALSE}.
7997
7998@item
7999Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8000
8001@item
8002Set constants are not yet supported.
8003@end itemize
8004
6d2ebf8b 8005@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8006@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8007@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8008
8009If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8010both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8011Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8012selected the working language.
8013
8014If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8015code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8016working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8017the language automatically}, for further details.
8018
6d2ebf8b 8019@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8020@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8021@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8022
8023A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8024This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8025
8026@itemize @bullet
8027@item
8028Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8029integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8030debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8031pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8032through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8033returned a pointer.)
8034
8035@item
8036C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8037non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8038escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8039printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8040
8041@item
8042The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8043argument.
8044
8045@item
8046All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8047@end itemize
8048
6d2ebf8b 8049@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8050@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8051@cindex Modula-2 checks
8052
8053@quotation
8054@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8055range checking.
8056@end quotation
8057@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8058
8059@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8060
8061@itemize @bullet
8062@item
8063They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8064@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8065
8066@item
8067They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8068@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8069@end itemize
8070
8071As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8072whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8073
8074Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8075index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8076
6d2ebf8b 8077@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8078@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8079@cindex scope
41afff9a 8080@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8081@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8082@ifinfo
41afff9a 8083@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8084@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8085@end ifinfo
8086@iftex
41afff9a 8087@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8088@end iftex
8089
8090There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8091(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8092similar syntax:
8093
474c8240 8094@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8095
8096@var{module} . @var{id}
8097@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8098@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8099
8100@noindent
8101where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8102@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8103identifier within your program, except another module.
8104
8105Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8106specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8107found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8108enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8109
8110Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8111the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8112definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8113an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8114module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8115@var{module}.
8116
6d2ebf8b 8117@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8118@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8119
8120Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8121Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8122specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8123@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8124apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8125analogue in Modula-2.
8126
8127The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8128with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8129intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8130created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8131address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8132@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8133
8134@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8135In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8136interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8137
6d2ebf8b 8138@node Chill
cce74817
JM
8139@subsection Chill
8140
8141The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 8142from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
8143supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8144likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8145table.
8146
d4f3574e
SS
8147@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8148@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8149This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
8150of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8151
8152@menu
104c1213
JM
8153* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8154* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 8155* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 8156* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 8157* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
8158@end menu
8159
6d2ebf8b 8160@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
8161@subsubsection How modes are displayed
8162
8163The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 8164with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
8165slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8166provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
8167
8168@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8169@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
8170@table @code
8171@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8172@itemize @bullet
8173@item
8174@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8175UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8176@item
5d161b24 8177@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 8178@item
5d161b24 8179@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
8180@item
8181@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8182@smallexample
8183(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8184type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8185@end smallexample
8186If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8187@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8188@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8189@smallexample
8190@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8191@end smallexample
8192where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8193expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
8194@end itemize
8195
8196@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8197A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 8198the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
8199@smallexample
8200(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8201type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8202@end smallexample
8203
8204@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8205@itemize @bullet
8206@item
d4f3574e 8207@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
8208followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8209@item
8210@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8211@end itemize
8212
8213@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8214The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8215<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
8216list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8217the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
8218all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8219
8220@ignore
8221@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8222The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 8223type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
8224@end ignore
8225
5d161b24 8226@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8227@itemize @bullet
8228@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8229@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8230@smallexample
8231@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8232@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8233where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8234@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8235@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8236@smallexample
8237@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8238@end smallexample
8239where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
8240@end itemize
8241
5d161b24 8242@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8243@itemize @bullet
8244@item
8245@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8246@item
8247@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8248@end itemize
8249
8250@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8251Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8252
8253@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8254@itemize @bullet
8255@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8256@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8257@smallexample
8258@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8259@end smallexample
8260followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8261mode
cce74817 8262@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8263@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8264@smallexample
8265@code{BOOLS(<string
8266length>)}
8267@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8268@end itemize
8269
8270@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8271The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8272followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8273@smallexample
8274(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
8275type = ARRAY (1:42)
8276 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
8277 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8278@end smallexample
8279
5d161b24 8280@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 8281The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
8282list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8283of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8284OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
8285of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8286checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8287always displays all variant fields.
8288@smallexample
8289(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8290type = STRUCT (
8291 as x,
8292 bs x,
8293 CASE bs OF
8294 (karli):
8295 cs a
8296 (ott):
8297 ds x
8298 ESAC
8299)
8300@end smallexample
8301@end table
8302
6d2ebf8b 8303@node Locations
cce74817
JM
8304@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8305
8306A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8307
8308A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
8309the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8310Chill programs. How values are specified
8311is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8312
8313The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8314display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 8315
cce74817
JM
8316@smallexample
8317set result := EXPR
8318@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
8319
8320@noindent
8321This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 8322is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
8323
8324Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8325value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 8326mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
8327represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8328value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 8329operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 8330
6d2ebf8b
SS
8331Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8332@smallexample
8333@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 8334(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
8335location>}
8336@end smallexample
8337@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8338specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8339the entry point.
cce74817
JM
8340
8341@ignore
8342Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8343fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8344the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
8345implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8346na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8347<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
8348@code{__proc_copy}.
8349
8350Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8351the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8352like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8353mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8354
8355Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 8356...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 8357definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
8358of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8359structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8360braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 8361on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 8362memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 8363all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 8364@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
8365stuff ???)
8366@smallexample
8367(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8368[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8369@end smallexample
8370@end ignore
8371
8372Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8373(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
8374certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8375and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8376
8377A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
8378location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8379name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8380have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8381checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 8382therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 8383
cce74817
JM
8384@smallexample
8385(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8386@end smallexample
8387
6d2ebf8b 8388@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
8389@subsubsection Values and their Operations
8390
8391Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8392more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
8393data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8394such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 8395constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 8396when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
8397(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8398the values behind these locations.
8399
d4f3574e 8400This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
8401operations are legal to be used with such values.
8402
8403@table @code
8404@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
8405Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8406For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 8407chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
8408@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8409@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 8410
5d161b24 8411@ignore
cce74817
JM
8412@itemize @bullet
8413@item
8414@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 8415programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
8416@item
8417@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8418@item
8419@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8420@code{'M'})
8421@item
8422@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 8423mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 8424comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 8425@item
d4f3574e 8426@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 8427emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 8428procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
8429
8430@item
8431@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 8432enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
8433to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8434@item
8435@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8436programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8437@item
8438@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 8439(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
8440@end itemize
8441@end ignore
8442
8443@item Tuple Values
8444A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 8445name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
8446unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8447@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 8448
cce74817
JM
8449@itemize @bullet
8450@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8451@item @emph{Array Tuple}
8452@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8453Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 8454same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
8455@end itemize
8456
8457@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
8458A string element value is specified by
8459@smallexample
8460@code{<string value>(<index>)}
8461@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8462where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
8463value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8464the string.
8465
8466@item String Slice Value
8467A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8468spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8469expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8470@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8471The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8472string.
8473
8474@item Array Element Values
8475An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8476delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8477
8478@item Array Slice Values
8479An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8480@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
8481@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8482arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
8483which is part of the specified array.
8484
8485@item Structure Field Values
8486A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
8487name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8488in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
8489corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8490
8491@item Procedure Call Value
8492The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8493procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8494expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 8495effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 8496
d4f3574e 8497Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 8498
6d2ebf8b
SS
8499Values of time mode locations appear as
8500@smallexample
8501@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8502@end smallexample
8503
cce74817
JM
8504
8505@ignore
8506This is not implemented yet:
8507@item Built-in Value
8508@noindent
8509The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 8510
cce74817
JM
8511@table @code
8512@item @code{ADDR()}
8513@item @code{NUM()}
8514@item @code{PRED()}
8515@item @code{SUCC()}
8516@item @code{ABS()}
8517@item @code{CARD()}
8518@item @code{MAX()}
8519@item @code{MIN()}
8520@item @code{SIZE()}
8521@item @code{UPPER()}
8522@item @code{LOWER()}
8523@item @code{LENGTH()}
8524@item @code{SIN()}
8525@item @code{COS()}
8526@item @code{TAN()}
8527@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8528@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8529@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8530@item @code{EXP()}
8531@item @code{LN()}
8532@item @code{LOG()}
8533@item @code{SQRT()}
8534@end table
8535
8536For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8537chapter 1.6.
8538@end ignore
8539
8540@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8541The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8542current active process.
8543
8544@item Expression Values
8545The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8546the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8547incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8548corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8549causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8550which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8551operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8552
cce74817
JM
8553@table @code
8554@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8555@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8556@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8557Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8558
cce74817
JM
8559@item @code{=, /=}
8560Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8561
cce74817 8562@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8563@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8564Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8565
cce74817 8566@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8567@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8568Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8569
cce74817
JM
8570@item @code{-}
8571Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8572
cce74817
JM
8573@item @code{//}
8574String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8575
cce74817
JM
8576@item @code{()}
8577String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8578
cce74817
JM
8579@item @code{->}
8580Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8581address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8582location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8583
cce74817 8584@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8585@itemx @code{AND}
8586@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8587Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8588
cce74817 8589@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8590@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8591Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8592
cce74817
JM
8593@item @code{IN}
8594Membership operator.
8595@end table
8596@end table
8597
6d2ebf8b 8598@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8599@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8600
8601@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8602of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8603complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8604equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8605structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8606
8607Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8608index bounds and all built in procedures.
8609
8610Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8611check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8612operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8613functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8614language specification.
8615
cce74817
JM
8616All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8617off}.
8618
5d161b24 8619@ignore
53a5351d 8620@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8621see last paragraph ?
8622@end ignore
8623
6d2ebf8b 8624@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8625@subsubsection Chill defaults
8626
8627If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8628both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8629Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8630selected the working language.
8631
8632If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8633code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8634working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8635the language automatically}, for further details.
8636
6d2ebf8b 8637@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8638@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8639
d4f3574e 8640The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8641symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8642program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8643does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8644program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8645(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8646file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8647
8648@cindex symbol names
8649@cindex names of symbols
8650@cindex quoting names
8651Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8652characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8653most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8654source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8655are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8656ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8657@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8658@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8659
474c8240 8660@smallexample
c906108c 8661p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8663
8664@noindent
8665looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8666
8667@table @code
8668@kindex info address
b37052ae 8669@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8670@item info address @var{symbol}
8671Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8672variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8673local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8674is always stored.
8675
8676Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8677at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8678the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8679
3d67e040 8680@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8681@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8682@item info symbol @var{addr}
8683Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8684If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8685nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8686
474c8240 8687@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8688(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8689_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8690@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8691
8692@noindent
8693This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8694it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8695
c906108c 8696@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8697@item whatis @var{expr}
8698Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8699actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8700assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8701@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8702
8703@item whatis
8704Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8705
8706@kindex ptype
8707@item ptype @var{typename}
8708Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8709the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8710@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8711@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8712
d4f3574e 8713@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8714@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8715Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8716differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8717of just the name of the type.
8718
8719For example, for this variable declaration:
8720
474c8240 8721@smallexample
c906108c 8722struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8723@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8724
8725@noindent
8726the two commands give this output:
8727
474c8240 8728@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8729@group
8730(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8731type = struct complex
8732(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8733type = struct complex @{
8734 double real;
8735 double imag;
8736@}
8737@end group
474c8240 8738@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8739
8740@noindent
8741As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8742the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8743
8744@kindex info types
8745@item info types @var{regexp}
8746@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8747Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8748(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8749complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8750@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8751names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8752information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8753
8754This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8755@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8756lists all source files where a type is defined.
8757
b37052ae
EZ
8758@kindex info scope
8759@cindex local variables
8760@item info scope @var{addr}
8761List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8762accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8763preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8764scope defined by that location. For example:
8765
8766@smallexample
8767(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8768Scope for command_line_handler:
8769Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8770Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8771Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8772Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8773Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8774Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8775Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8776@end smallexample
8777
f5c37c66
EZ
8778@noindent
8779This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8780during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8781collect}.
8782
c906108c
SS
8783@kindex info source
8784@item info source
8785Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8786the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8787it was written in.
8788
8789@kindex info sources
8790@item info sources
8791Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8792debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8793have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8794
8795@kindex info functions
8796@item info functions
8797Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8798
8799@item info functions @var{regexp}
8800Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8801whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8802Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8803include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8804start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8805that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8806@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8807
8808@kindex info variables
8809@item info variables
8810Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8811outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8812
8813@item info variables @var{regexp}
8814Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8815variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8816@var{regexp}.
8817
8818@ignore
8819This was never implemented.
8820@kindex info methods
8821@item info methods
8822@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8823The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8824methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8825specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8826C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8827from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8828@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8829which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8830@end ignore
8831
c906108c
SS
8832@cindex reloading symbols
8833Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8834be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8835in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8836running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8837@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8838
8839@table @code
8840@kindex set symbol-reloading
8841@item set symbol-reloading on
8842Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8843object file with a particular name is seen again.
8844
8845@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8846Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8847same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8848running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8849should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8850may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8851several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8852name.
c906108c
SS
8853
8854@kindex show symbol-reloading
8855@item show symbol-reloading
8856Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8857@end table
c906108c 8858
c906108c
SS
8859@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8860@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8861Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8862declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8863@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8864source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8865another source file. The default is on.
8866
8867A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8868the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8869
8870@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8871Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8872is printed as follows:
8873@smallexample
8874@{<no data fields>@}
8875@end smallexample
8876
8877@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8878@item show opaque-type-resolution
8879Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8880
8881@kindex maint print symbols
8882@cindex symbol dump
8883@kindex maint print psymbols
8884@cindex partial symbol dump
8885@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8886@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8887@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8888Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8889These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8890symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8891symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8892collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8893only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8894command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8895use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8896symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8897files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8898@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8899required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8900@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8901@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8902@end table
8903
6d2ebf8b 8904@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8905@chapter Altering Execution
8906
8907Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8908find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8909correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8910experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8911program.
8912
8913For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8914locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8915address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8916
8917@menu
8918* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8919* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8920* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8921* Returning:: Returning from a function
8922* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8923* Patching:: Patching your program
8924@end menu
8925
6d2ebf8b 8926@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8927@section Assignment to variables
8928
8929@cindex assignment
8930@cindex setting variables
8931To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8932@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8933
474c8240 8934@smallexample
c906108c 8935print x=4
474c8240 8936@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8937
8938@noindent
8939stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8940value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8941@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8942information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8943
8944@kindex set variable
8945@cindex variables, setting
8946If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8947@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8948really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8949not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8950,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8951
c906108c
SS
8952If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8953appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8954variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8955to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8956program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8957a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8958command @code{set width}:
8959
474c8240 8960@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8961(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8962type = double
8963(@value{GDBP}) p width
8964$4 = 13
8965(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8966Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 8967@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8968
8969@noindent
8970The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8971order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8972
474c8240 8973@smallexample
c906108c 8974(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 8975@end smallexample
53a5351d 8976
c906108c
SS
8977Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8978with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8979@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8980your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8981to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8982the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8983
474c8240 8984@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8985@group
8986(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8987type = double
8988(@value{GDBP}) p g
8989$1 = 1
8990(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8991(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8992$2 = 1
8993(@value{GDBP}) r
8994The program being debugged has been started already.
8995Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8996Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8997"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8998 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8999(@value{GDBP}) show g
9000The current BFD target is "=4".
9001@end group
474c8240 9002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9003
9004@noindent
9005The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9006@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9007@code{g}, use
9008
474c8240 9009@smallexample
c906108c 9010(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9011@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9012
9013@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9014freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9015and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9016same length or shorter.
9017@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9018@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9019
9020To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9021construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9022(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9023to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9024and representation in memory), and
9025
474c8240 9026@smallexample
c906108c 9027set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9028@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9029
9030@noindent
9031stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9032
6d2ebf8b 9033@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9034@section Continuing at a different address
9035
9036Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9037it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9038an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9039
9040@table @code
9041@kindex jump
9042@item jump @var{linespec}
9043Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9044immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9045source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9046@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9047in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9048breakpoints}.
9049
9050The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9051the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9052register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9053a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9054be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9055of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9056confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9057executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9058well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9059
9060@item jump *@var{address}
9061Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9062@end table
9063
c906108c 9064@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9065On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9066command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9067difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9068changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9069example,
c906108c 9070
474c8240 9071@smallexample
c906108c 9072set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9073@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9074
9075@noindent
9076makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9077address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9078@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9079
9080The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9081up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9082that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9083detail.
9084
c906108c 9085@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9086@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9087@section Giving your program a signal
9088
9089@table @code
9090@kindex signal
9091@item signal @var{signal}
9092Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9093signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9094signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9095SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9096
9097Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9098giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9099a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9100@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9101signal.
9102
9103@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9104after executing the command.
9105@end table
9106@c @end group
9107
9108Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9109@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9110causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9111the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9112passes the signal directly to your program.
9113
c906108c 9114
6d2ebf8b 9115@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9116@section Returning from a function
9117
9118@table @code
9119@cindex returning from a function
9120@kindex return
9121@item return
9122@itemx return @var{expression}
9123You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9124command. If you give an
9125@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9126value.
9127@end table
9128
9129When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9130(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9131discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9132be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9133
9134This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9135frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9136innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9137specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9138of functions.
9139
9140The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9141program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9142returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9143and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9144selected stack frame returns naturally.
9145
6d2ebf8b 9146@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9147@section Calling program functions
9148
9149@cindex calling functions
9150@kindex call
9151@table @code
9152@item call @var{expr}
9153Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9154returned values.
9155@end table
9156
9157You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9158execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9159with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9160is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9161
6d2ebf8b 9162@node Patching
c906108c 9163@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9164
c906108c
SS
9165@cindex patching binaries
9166@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9167@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9168
7a292a7a
SS
9169By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9170executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9171alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9172patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9173
9174If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9175explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9176want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9177repairs.
9178
9179@table @code
9180@kindex set write
9181@item set write on
9182@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9183If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9184core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9185off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9186
9187If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9188@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9189write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9190
9191@item show write
9192@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9193Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9194as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9195@end table
9196
6d2ebf8b 9197@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9198@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9199
7a292a7a
SS
9200@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9201both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9202program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9203@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9204
9205@menu
9206* Files:: Commands to specify files
9207* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9208@end menu
9209
6d2ebf8b 9210@node Files
c906108c 9211@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9212
7a292a7a 9213@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9214@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9215
9216You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9217way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9218@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9219Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9220
9221Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9222@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9223a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9224to specify new files are useful.
9225
9226@table @code
9227@cindex executable file
9228@kindex file
9229@item file @var{filename}
9230Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9231symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9232executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9233directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9234@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9235directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9236to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9237and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9238
6d2ebf8b 9239On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9240@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9241@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9242@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9243descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9244(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9245@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9246for more information.
c906108c
SS
9247
9248@item file
9249@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9250has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9251
9252@kindex exec-file
9253@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9254Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9255in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9256if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9257discard information on the executable file.
9258
9259@kindex symbol-file
9260@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9261Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9262searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9263table and program to run from the same file.
9264
9265@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9266program's symbol table.
9267
5d161b24 9268The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9269of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9270auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9271the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9272the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9273
9274@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9275executing it once.
9276
9277When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9278understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9279generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9280other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9281Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9282using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9283optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9284
9285For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9286using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9287symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9288quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9289details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9290
9291The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9292start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9293occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9294file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9295pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9296warnings and messages}.)
9297
c906108c
SS
9298We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9299symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9300symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9301still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9302in stabs format.
9303
9304@kindex readnow
9305@cindex reading symbols immediately
9306@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9307@kindex mapped
9308@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9309@cindex saving symbol table
9310@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9311@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9312You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9313tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9314load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9315entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9316
c906108c
SS
9317If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9318@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9319cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9320file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9321from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9322than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9323program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9324starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9325
9326You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9327file has all the symbol information for your program.
9328
9329The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9330@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9331than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9332it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9333needed.
9334
9335The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9336@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9337symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9338
9339@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9340@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9341@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9342@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9343@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9344@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9345@c files.
9346
9347@kindex core
9348@kindex core-file
9349@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9350Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9351of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9352address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9353executable file itself for other parts.
9354
9355@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9356to be used.
9357
9358Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9359under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9360wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9361the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9362(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9363
c906108c
SS
9364@kindex add-symbol-file
9365@cindex dynamic linking
9366@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9367@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9368@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9369The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9370information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9371when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9372into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9373address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9374this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9375of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9376section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9377@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9378
9379The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9380originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9381@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9382thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9383instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9384
17d9d558
JB
9385@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9386@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9387@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9388@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9389@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9390Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9391executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9392relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9393information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9394
9395@itemize @bullet
9396@item
9397the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9398that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9399@item
9400every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9401been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9402@item
9403you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9404provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9405@end itemize
9406
9407@noindent
9408Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9409relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9410typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9411important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9412procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9413assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9414general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9415relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9416as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9417way.
9418
c906108c
SS
9419@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9420
9421You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9422the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9423table information for @var{filename}.
9424
9425@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9426@item add-shared-symbol-file
9427The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9428operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9429shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9430@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9431
c906108c
SS
9432@kindex section
9433@item section
5d161b24
DB
9434The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9435the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9436section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9437specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9438separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9439the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9440
9441@kindex info files
9442@kindex info target
9443@item info files
9444@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9445@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9446current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9447including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9448use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9449command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9450current ones.
9451
fe95c787
MS
9452@kindex maint info sections
9453@item maint info sections
9454Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9455is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9456displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9457offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9458@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9459may be arbitrarily combined):
9460
9461@table @code
9462@item ALLOBJ
9463Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9464@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9465Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9466@item @var{section-flags}
9467Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9468The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9469@table @code
9470@item ALLOC
9471Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9472Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9473@item LOAD
9474Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9475Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9476@item RELOC
9477Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9478@item READONLY
9479Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9480@item CODE
9481Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9482@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9483Section contains data only (no executable code).
9484@item ROM
9485Section will reside in ROM.
9486@item CONSTRUCTOR
9487Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9488@item HAS_CONTENTS
9489Section is not empty.
9490@item NEVER_LOAD
9491An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9492@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9493A notification to the linker that the section contains
9494COFF shared library information.
9495@item IS_COMMON
9496Section contains common symbols.
9497@end table
9498@end table
6763aef9
MS
9499@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9500@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9501Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9502really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9503In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9504out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9505For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9506enhancement to debugging performance.
9507
9508The default is off.
9509
9510@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9511Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9512the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9513and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9514@end table
9515
9516All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9517as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9518name and remembers it that way.
9519
c906108c 9520@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9521@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9522libraries.
53a5351d 9523
c906108c
SS
9524@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9525when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9526(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9527references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9528debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9529
9530On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9531automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9532
c906108c
SS
9533@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9534@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9535@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9536
b7209cb4
FF
9537There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9538symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9539particularly large or there are many of them.
9540
9541To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9542commands:
9543
9544@table @code
9545@kindex set auto-solib-add
9546@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9547If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9548will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9549attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9550informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9551is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9552@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9553
9554@kindex show auto-solib-add
9555@item show auto-solib-add
9556Display the current autoloading mode.
9557@end table
9558
9559To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9560command:
9561
c906108c
SS
9562@table @code
9563@kindex info sharedlibrary
9564@kindex info share
9565@item info share
9566@itemx info sharedlibrary
9567Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9568
9569@kindex sharedlibrary
9570@kindex share
9571@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9572@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9573Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9574Unix regular expression.
9575As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9576required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9577@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9578loaded.
9579@end table
9580
b7209cb4
FF
9581On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9582autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9583reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9584by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9585up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9586wish.
c906108c
SS
9587
9588Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9589loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9590@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9591automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9592
9593To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9594
9595@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9596@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9597@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9598Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9599If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9600symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9601size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9602Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9603@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9604Mb).
c906108c 9605
b7209cb4
FF
9606@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9607@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9608Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9609@end table
c906108c 9610
6d2ebf8b 9611@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9612@section Errors reading symbol files
9613
9614While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9615such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9616output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9617they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9618debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9619about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9620only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9621times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9622to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9623complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9624messages}).
9625
9626The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9627
9628@table @code
9629@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9630
9631The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9632(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9633error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9634in its outer scope blocks.
9635
9636@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9637the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9638may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9639function.
9640
9641@item block at @var{address} out of order
9642
9643The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9644order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9645do so.
9646
9647@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9648locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9649can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9650@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9651messages}.)
9652
9653@item bad block start address patched
9654
9655The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9656smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9657to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9658
9659@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9660starting on the previous source line.
9661
9662@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9663
9664@cindex foo
9665Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9666larger than the size of the string table.
9667
9668@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9669name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9670with this name.
9671
9672@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9673
7a292a7a
SS
9674The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9675not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9676uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9677
7a292a7a
SS
9678@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9679This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9680are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9681debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9682on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9683and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9684
9685@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9686
7a292a7a 9687@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9688
7a292a7a 9689@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9690The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9691information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9692it.
c906108c
SS
9693
9694@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9695
9696@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9697
c906108c
SS
9698@end table
9699
6d2ebf8b 9700@node Targets
c906108c 9701@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9702
c906108c
SS
9703@cindex debugging target
9704@kindex target
9705
9706A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9707
9708Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9709in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9710you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9711flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9712host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9713realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9714command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9715(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9716
9717@menu
9718* Active Targets:: Active targets
9719* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9720* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9721* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9722* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9723
9724@end menu
9725
6d2ebf8b 9726@node Active Targets
c906108c 9727@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9728
c906108c
SS
9729@cindex stacking targets
9730@cindex active targets
9731@cindex multiple targets
9732
c906108c 9733There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9734executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9735active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9736start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9737a core file.
c906108c
SS
9738
9739For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9740@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9741well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9742@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9743first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9744requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9745are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9746read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9747executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9748
9749When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9750target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9751commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9752an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9753process target is active.
c906108c 9754
7a292a7a
SS
9755Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9756core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9757files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9758the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9759process}).
c906108c 9760
6d2ebf8b 9761@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9762@section Commands for managing targets
9763
9764@table @code
9765@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9766Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9767process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9768facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9769protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9770
9771Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9772typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9773with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9774
9775The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9776after executing the command.
9777
9778@kindex help target
9779@item help target
9780Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9781currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9782(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9783
9784@item help target @var{name}
9785Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9786select it.
9787
9788@kindex set gnutarget
9789@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9790@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9791knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9792a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9793with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9794with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9795
d4f3574e 9796@quotation
c906108c
SS
9797@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9798you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9799@end quotation
c906108c 9800
d4f3574e
SS
9801@noindent
9802@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9803
5d161b24 9804@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9805@item show gnutarget
9806Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9807@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9808@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9809and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9810@end table
9811
c906108c
SS
9812Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9813configuration):
c906108c
SS
9814
9815@table @code
9816@kindex target exec
9817@item target exec @var{program}
9818An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9819@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9820
c906108c
SS
9821@kindex target core
9822@item target core @var{filename}
9823A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9824@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9825
9826@kindex target remote
9827@item target remote @var{dev}
9828Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9829specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9830@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9831supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9832some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9833it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9834
c906108c
SS
9835@kindex target sim
9836@item target sim
2df3850c 9837Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 9838In general,
474c8240 9839@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9840 target sim
9841 load
9842 run
474c8240 9843@end smallexample
d4f3574e 9844@noindent
104c1213 9845works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9846drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9847provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9848see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9849Processors}.
9850
c906108c
SS
9851@end table
9852
104c1213 9853Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9854
9855@table @code
9856
c906108c
SS
9857@kindex target nrom
9858@item target nrom @var{dev}
9859NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9860
c906108c
SS
9861@end table
9862
5d161b24 9863Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9864your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9865
9866Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9867once you've successfully established a connection.
9868
9869@table @code
9870
9871@kindex load @var{filename}
9872@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9873Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9874@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9875is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9876on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9877@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9878the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9879
9880If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9881execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9882target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9883
9884The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9885For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9886link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9887specifies a fixed address.
9888@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9889
c906108c
SS
9890@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9891@end table
9892
6d2ebf8b 9893@node Byte Order
c906108c 9894@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9895
c906108c
SS
9896@cindex choosing target byte order
9897@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9898
9899Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9900offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9901orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9902designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9903which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9904@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9905
9906@table @code
9907@kindex set endian big
9908@item set endian big
9909Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9910
9911@kindex set endian little
9912@item set endian little
9913Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9914
9915@kindex set endian auto
9916@item set endian auto
9917Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9918executable.
9919
9920@item show endian
9921Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9922
9923@end table
9924
9925Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9926data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9927target system.
9928
6d2ebf8b 9929@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9930@section Remote debugging
9931@cindex remote debugging
9932
9933If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9934@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9935For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9936or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9937powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9938
9939Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9940to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9941@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9942but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9943write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9944communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9945
9946Other remote targets may be available in your
9947configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9948
6f05cf9f
AC
9949@node KOD
9950@section Kernel Object Display
9951
9952@cindex kernel object display
9953@cindex kernel object
9954@cindex KOD
9955
9956Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9957@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9958and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9959mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9960displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9961
9962Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9963@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9964
474c8240 9965@smallexample
6f05cf9f 9966(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 9967@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
9968
9969If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9970about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9971which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9972after the operating system:
c906108c 9973
474c8240 9974@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
9975(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9976List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9977Object Description
9978any Any and all objects
474c8240 9979@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
9980
9981Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9982by the kernel.
9983
9984There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9985is supported other than to try it.
9986
9987
9988@node Remote Debugging
9989@chapter Debugging remote programs
9990
6b2f586d
AC
9991@menu
9992* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
9993* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
9994* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
9995@end menu
9996
6f05cf9f
AC
9997@node Server
9998@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9999
10000@kindex gdbserver
10001@cindex remote connection without stubs
10002@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10003allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10004@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10005
10006@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10007because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10008that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10009@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10010@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10011because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10012also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10013started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10014Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10015the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10016do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10017by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10018choice for debugging.
10019
10020@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10021or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10022protocol.
10023
10024@table @emph
10025@item On the target machine,
10026you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10027@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10028strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10029system does all the symbol handling.
10030
10031To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10032the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10033syntax is:
10034
10035@smallexample
10036target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10037@end smallexample
10038
10039@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10040hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10041@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10042@file{/dev/com1}:
10043
10044@smallexample
10045target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10046@end smallexample
10047
10048@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10049with it.
10050
10051To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10052
10053@smallexample
10054target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10055@end smallexample
10056
10057The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10058specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10059TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10060expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10061(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10062you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10063TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10064reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10065conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10066and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10067@code{target remote} command.
10068
56460a61
DJ
10069On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10070This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10071
10072@smallexample
10073target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10074@end smallexample
10075
10076@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10077to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10078
6f05cf9f
AC
10079@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10080you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10081symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10082using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10083(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10084running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10085remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10086is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10087@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10088@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10089
10090@smallexample
10091(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10092@end smallexample
10093
10094@noindent
10095communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10096
10097@smallexample
10098(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10099@end smallexample
10100
10101@noindent
10102communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10103For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10104the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10105text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10106@samp{Connection refused}.
10107@end table
10108
10109@node NetWare
10110@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10111
10112@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10113@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10114allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10115@code{target remote}.
10116
10117@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10118using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10119
10120@table @emph
10121@item On the target machine,
10122you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10123@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10124can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10125host system does all the symbol handling.
10126
10127To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10128@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10129program. The syntax is:
10130
10131@smallexample
10132load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10133 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10134@end smallexample
10135
10136@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10137the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10138to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10139
10140For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10141communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10142using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10143
10144@smallexample
10145load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10146@end smallexample
10147
10148@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10149you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10150symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10151using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10152(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10153running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10154remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10155argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10156@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10157
10158@smallexample
10159(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10160@end smallexample
10161
10162@noindent
10163communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10164@end table
10165
10166@node remote stub
10167@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10168
8e04817f
AC
10169@cindex debugging stub, example
10170@cindex remote stub, example
10171@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10172The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10173communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10174@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10175these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10176implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10177with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10178organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10179
104c1213
JM
10180@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10181To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10182@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10183prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10184program, you need:
c906108c 10185
104c1213
JM
10186@enumerate
10187@item
10188A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10189have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10190your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10191
5d161b24 10192@item
d4f3574e 10193A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10194subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10195
104c1213
JM
10196@item
10197A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10198download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10199manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10200documentation.
10201@end enumerate
96baa820 10202
104c1213
JM
10203The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10204communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10205machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10206
104c1213
JM
10207@table @emph
10208@item On the host,
10209@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10210else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10211(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10212
10213@item On the target,
10214you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10215implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10216subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10217
10218On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10219@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10220@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10221@end table
96baa820 10222
104c1213
JM
10223The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10224machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10225@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10226
104c1213
JM
10227@cindex remote serial stub list
10228These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10229
104c1213
JM
10230@table @code
10231
10232@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10233@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10234@cindex Intel
10235@cindex i386
10236For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10237
10238@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10239@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10240@cindex Motorola 680x0
10241@cindex m680x0
10242For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10243
10244@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10245@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10246@cindex Hitachi
10247@cindex SH
10248For Hitachi SH architectures.
10249
10250@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10251@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10252@cindex Sparc
10253For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10254
10255@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10256@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10257@cindex Fujitsu
10258@cindex SparcLite
10259For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10260
10261@end table
10262
10263The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10264recently added stubs.
10265
10266@menu
10267* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10268* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10269* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10270@end menu
10271
6d2ebf8b 10272@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10273@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10274
10275@cindex remote serial stub
10276The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10277subroutines:
10278
10279@table @code
10280@item set_debug_traps
10281@kindex set_debug_traps
10282@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10283This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10284program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10285beginning of your program.
10286
10287@item handle_exception
10288@kindex handle_exception
10289@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10290This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10291explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10292run when a trap is triggered.
10293
10294@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10295execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10296with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10297protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10298representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10299information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10300retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10301execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10302@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10303machine.
104c1213
JM
10304
10305@item breakpoint
10306@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10307Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10308breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10309way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10310machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10311pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10312@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10313simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10314again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10315your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10316@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10317
10318Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10319to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10320start of your debugging session.
10321@end table
10322
6d2ebf8b 10323@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10324@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10325
10326@cindex remote stub, support routines
10327The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10328chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10329debugging target machine.
10330
10331First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10332serial port.
10333
10334@table @code
10335@item int getDebugChar()
10336@kindex getDebugChar
10337Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10338It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10339different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10340
10341@item void putDebugChar(int)
10342@kindex putDebugChar
10343Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10344It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10345different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10346@end table
10347
10348@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10349@cindex interrupting remote targets
10350If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10351running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10352for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10353character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10354remote system to stop.
10355
10356Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10357probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10358is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10359@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10360
10361Other routines you need to supply are:
10362
10363@table @code
10364@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10365@kindex exceptionHandler
10366Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10367handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10368way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10369are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10370containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10371@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10372its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10373might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10374exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10375@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10376and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10377you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10378should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10379
10380For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10381gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10382should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10383@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10384help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10385
10386@item void flush_i_cache()
10387@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10388On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10389instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10390instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10391
10392On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10393function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10394@end table
10395
10396@noindent
10397You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10398
10399@table @code
10400@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10401@kindex memset
10402This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10403memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10404@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10405either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10406@end table
10407
10408If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10409library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10410but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10411subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10412
10413
6d2ebf8b 10414@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10415@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10416
10417@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10418In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10419steps.
10420
10421@enumerate
10422@item
6d2ebf8b 10423Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10424(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10425@display
10426@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10427@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10428@end display
10429
10430@item
10431Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10432
474c8240 10433@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10434set_debug_traps();
10435breakpoint();
474c8240 10436@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10437
10438@item
10439For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10440@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10441
474c8240 10442@smallexample
104c1213 10443void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10444@end smallexample
104c1213 10445
d4f3574e 10446@noindent
104c1213 10447but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10448function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10449@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10450error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10451one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10452
10453@item
10454Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10455your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10456
10457@item
10458Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10459the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10460
10461@item
10462@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10463@c document that. FIXME.
10464Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10465whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10466
10467@item
10468To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10469as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10470This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10471of its pure text.
10472
d4f3574e 10473@item
104c1213 10474@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10475Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10476Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10477machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10478TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10479to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10480device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10481
474c8240 10482@smallexample
104c1213 10483target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10484@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10485
10486@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10487To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10488@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10489For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10490terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10491
474c8240 10492@smallexample
104c1213 10493target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10494@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10495
10496If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10497your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10498the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10499to port 1234 on your local machine:
10500
474c8240 10501@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10502target remote :1234
474c8240 10503@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10504@noindent
10505
10506Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10507
10508@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10509To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10510@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10511on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10512
10513@smallexample
10514target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10515@end smallexample
10516
10517When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10518that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10519busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10520session.
10521
104c1213
JM
10522@end enumerate
10523
10524Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10525step and continue the remote program.
10526
10527To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10528command.
10529
10530@cindex interrupting remote programs
10531@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10532Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10533interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10534program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10535and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10536interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10537
474c8240 10538@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10539Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10540Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10541@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10542
10543If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10544(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10545remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10546goes back to waiting.
10547
104c1213 10548
8e04817f
AC
10549@node Configurations
10550@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10551
8e04817f
AC
10552While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10553cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10554describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10555
8e04817f
AC
10556There are three major categories of configurations: native
10557configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10558operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10559different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10560are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10561
8e04817f
AC
10562@menu
10563* Native::
10564* Embedded OS::
10565* Embedded Processors::
10566* Architectures::
10567@end menu
104c1213 10568
8e04817f
AC
10569@node Native
10570@section Native
104c1213 10571
8e04817f
AC
10572This section describes details specific to particular native
10573configurations.
6cf7e474 10574
8e04817f
AC
10575@menu
10576* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10577* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10578* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10579* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10580@end menu
6cf7e474 10581
8e04817f
AC
10582@node HP-UX
10583@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10584
8e04817f
AC
10585On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10586begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10587name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10588
8e04817f
AC
10589@node SVR4 Process Information
10590@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10591
8e04817f
AC
10592@kindex /proc
10593@cindex process image
104c1213 10594
8e04817f
AC
10595Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10596used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10597subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10598this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10599several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10600@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10601@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10602and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
104c1213 10603
8e04817f
AC
10604@table @code
10605@kindex info proc
10606@item info proc
10607Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10608
8e04817f
AC
10609@kindex info proc mappings
10610@item info proc mappings
10611Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10612on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10613@ignore
10614@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10615@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10616@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10617@kindex info proc times
10618@item info proc times
10619Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10620its children.
6cf7e474 10621
8e04817f
AC
10622@kindex info proc id
10623@item info proc id
10624Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10625the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10626
8e04817f
AC
10627@kindex info proc status
10628@item info proc status
10629General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10630stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10631received.
d4f3574e 10632
8e04817f
AC
10633@item info proc all
10634Show all the above information about the process.
10635@end ignore
10636@end table
104c1213 10637
8e04817f
AC
10638@node DJGPP Native
10639@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10640@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10641@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10642@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10643
8e04817f
AC
10644@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10645MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10646that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10647top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10648
8e04817f
AC
10649@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10650defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10651subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10652
8e04817f
AC
10653@table @code
10654@kindex info dos
10655@item info dos
10656This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10657information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10658
8e04817f
AC
10659@kindex sysinfo
10660@cindex MS-DOS system info
10661@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10662@item info dos sysinfo
10663This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10664platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10665DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10666
8e04817f
AC
10667@cindex GDT
10668@cindex LDT
10669@cindex IDT
10670@cindex segment descriptor tables
10671@cindex descriptor tables display
10672@item info dos gdt
10673@itemx info dos ldt
10674@itemx info dos idt
10675These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10676and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10677tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10678that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10679descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10680descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10681rights.
104c1213 10682
8e04817f
AC
10683A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10684segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10685allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10686conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10687additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10688
8e04817f
AC
10689@cindex garbled pointers
10690These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10691Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10692displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10693display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10694example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10695debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10696
8e04817f
AC
10697@smallexample
10698@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10699@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10700@end smallexample
104c1213 10701
8e04817f
AC
10702@noindent
10703This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10704the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10705
8e04817f
AC
10706@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10707@item info dos pde
10708@itemx info dos pte
10709These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10710Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10711data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10712into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10713page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10714may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10715Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10716that is currently in use.
104c1213 10717
8e04817f
AC
10718Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10719Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10720the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10721@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10722Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10723means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10724the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10725
8e04817f
AC
10726@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10727These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10728Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10729controller.
104c1213 10730
8e04817f 10731These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10732
8e04817f
AC
10733@cindex physical address from linear address
10734@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10735This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10736address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10737appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10738accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10739example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10740the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10741
8e04817f
AC
10742@smallexample
10743@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10744@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10745@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10746@end smallexample
104c1213 10747
8e04817f
AC
10748@noindent
10749This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10750whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10751attributes of that page.
104c1213 10752
8e04817f
AC
10753Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10754since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10755address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10756be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10757declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10758@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10759
8e04817f
AC
10760Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10761transfer buffer:
104c1213 10762
8e04817f
AC
10763@smallexample
10764@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10765@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10766@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10767@end smallexample
104c1213 10768
8e04817f
AC
10769@noindent
10770(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
107713rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10772this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10773mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10774
8e04817f
AC
10775This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10776@end table
104c1213 10777
78c47bea
PM
10778@node Cygwin Native
10779@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10780@cindex MS Windows debugging
10781@cindex native Cygwin debugging
10782@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10783
10784@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10785defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10786subsection describes those commands.
10787
10788@table @code
10789@kindex info w32
10790@item info w32
10791This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10792information about the target system and important OS structures.
10793
10794@item info w32 selector
10795This command displays information returned by
10796the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10797It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10798a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10799Without argument, this command displays information
10800about the the six segment registers.
10801
10802@kindex info dll
10803@item info dll
10804This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10805
10806@kindex dll-symbols
10807@item dll-symbols
10808This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10809add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10810
10811@kindex set new-console
10812@item set new-console @var{mode}
10813If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10814be started in a new console on next start.
10815If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10816be started in the same console as the debugger.
10817
10818@kindex show new-console
10819@item show new-console
10820Displays whether a new console is used
10821when the debuggee is started.
10822
10823@kindex set new-group
10824@item set new-group @var{mode}
10825This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10826start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10827This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10828Ctrl-C.
10829
10830@kindex show new-group
10831@item show new-group
10832Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10833
10834@kindex set debugevents
10835@item set debugevents
10836This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10837
10838@kindex set debugexec
10839@item set debugexec
10840This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10841seen by the debugger.
10842
10843@kindex set debugexceptions
10844@item set debugexceptions
10845This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10846seen by the debugger.
10847
10848@kindex set debugmemory
10849@item set debugmemory
10850This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10851seen by the debugger.
10852
10853@kindex set shell
10854@item set shell
10855This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10856via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10857
10858@kindex show shell
10859@item show shell
10860Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10861
10862@end table
10863
8e04817f
AC
10864@node Embedded OS
10865@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 10866
8e04817f
AC
10867This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10868embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10869architectures.
d4f3574e 10870
8e04817f
AC
10871@menu
10872* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10873@end menu
104c1213 10874
8e04817f
AC
10875@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10876various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 10877
8e04817f
AC
10878@node VxWorks
10879@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 10880
8e04817f 10881@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 10882
8e04817f 10883@table @code
104c1213 10884
8e04817f
AC
10885@kindex target vxworks
10886@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10887A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10888is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 10889
8e04817f 10890@end table
104c1213 10891
8e04817f
AC
10892On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10893current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 10894
8e04817f
AC
10895@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10896VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10897the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10898both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10899@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10900installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10901@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 10902
8e04817f
AC
10903@table @code
10904@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10905@kindex vxworks-timeout
10906All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10907This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10908seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10909your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10910of a thin network line.
10911@end table
104c1213 10912
8e04817f
AC
10913The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10914this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10915procedures.
104c1213 10916
8e04817f
AC
10917@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10918To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10919to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10920library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10921VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10922kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10923source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10924information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10925manual.
10926@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 10927
8e04817f
AC
10928Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10929your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10930run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10931@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 10932
8e04817f 10933@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 10934
474c8240 10935@smallexample
8e04817f 10936(vxgdb)
474c8240 10937@end smallexample
104c1213 10938
8e04817f
AC
10939@menu
10940* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10941* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10942* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10943@end menu
104c1213 10944
8e04817f
AC
10945@node VxWorks Connection
10946@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 10947
8e04817f
AC
10948The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10949network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 10950
474c8240 10951@smallexample
8e04817f 10952(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 10953@end smallexample
104c1213 10954
8e04817f
AC
10955@need 750
10956@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 10957
8e04817f
AC
10958@smallexample
10959Attaching remote machine across net...
10960Connected to tt.
10961@end smallexample
104c1213 10962
8e04817f
AC
10963@need 1000
10964@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10965loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10966these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10967path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10968to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 10969
474c8240 10970@smallexample
8e04817f 10971prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 10972@end smallexample
104c1213 10973
8e04817f
AC
10974When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10975the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10976command again.
104c1213 10977
8e04817f
AC
10978@node VxWorks Download
10979@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 10980
8e04817f
AC
10981@cindex download to VxWorks
10982If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10983object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10984@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10985incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10986command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10987to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10988table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10989the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10990filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10991Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10992to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10993the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10994@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10995and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10996program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 10997
474c8240 10998@smallexample
8e04817f 10999-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11000@end smallexample
104c1213 11001
8e04817f
AC
11002@noindent
11003Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11004
474c8240 11005@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11006(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11007(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11008@end smallexample
104c1213 11009
8e04817f 11010@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11011
8e04817f
AC
11012@smallexample
11013Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11014@end smallexample
104c1213 11015
8e04817f
AC
11016You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11017after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11018this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11019auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11020history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11021debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11022table.)
104c1213 11023
8e04817f
AC
11024@node VxWorks Attach
11025@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11026
11027@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11028You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11029follows:
11030
474c8240 11031@smallexample
104c1213 11032(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11033@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11034
11035@noindent
11036where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11037or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11038the time of attachment.
11039
6d2ebf8b 11040@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11041@section Embedded Processors
11042
11043This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11044configurations.
11045
7d86b5d5 11046
104c1213 11047@menu
104c1213
JM
11048* ARM:: ARM
11049* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11050* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11051* i960:: Intel i960
11052* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11053* M68K:: Motorola M68K
11054* M88K:: Motorola M88K
11055* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11056* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11057* PowerPC: PowerPC
11058* SH:: Hitachi SH
11059* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11060* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11061* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11062* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11063@end menu
11064
6d2ebf8b 11065@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11066@subsection ARM
11067
11068@table @code
11069
8e04817f
AC
11070@kindex target rdi
11071@item target rdi @var{dev}
11072ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11073use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11074monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11075
11076@kindex target rdp
11077@item target rdp @var{dev}
11078ARM Demon monitor.
11079
11080@end table
11081
11082@node H8/300
11083@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11084
11085@table @code
11086
11087@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11088@item target hms @var{dev}
11089A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11090Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11091line and the communications speed used.
11092
11093@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11094@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11095E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11096
11097@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11098@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11099@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11100@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11101Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11102
11103@end table
11104
11105@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11106@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11107@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11108@cindex Hitachi SH download
11109When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11110board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11111board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11112@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11113
11114@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11115Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11116
11117@enumerate
11118@item
11119that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11120for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11121emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11122the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11123H8/300, or H8/500.)
11124
11125@item
11126what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11127serial device available on your host is the default).
11128
11129@item
11130what speed to use over the serial device.
11131@end enumerate
11132
11133@menu
11134* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11135* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11136* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11137@end menu
11138
11139@node Hitachi Boards
11140@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11141
11142@c only for Unix hosts
11143@kindex device
11144@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11145Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11146need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11147first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11148hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11149
11150@kindex speed
11151@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11152@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11153speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11154hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11155the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11156@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11157
11158The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11159use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11160use a DOS host,
11161@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11162called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11163through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11164to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11165
11166The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11167program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11168sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11169the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11170
11171First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11172board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11173port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11174When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11175debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11176for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11177@code{COM2}.
11178
474c8240 11179@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11180C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11181C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11182
11183Resident portion of MODE loaded
11184
11185COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11186
474c8240 11187@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11188
11189@quotation
11190@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11191@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11192disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11193your development board.
11194@end quotation
11195
11196@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11197Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11198connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11199the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11200you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11201commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11202cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11203download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11204the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11205(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11206executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11207@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11208itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11209
11210@smallexample
11211(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11212@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11213 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11214 the conditions.
11215There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11216for details.
11217@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11218(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11219Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11220(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11221.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11222.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11223.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11224@end smallexample
11225
11226At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11227you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11228sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11229@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11230resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11231@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11232
11233Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11234available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11235you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11236
11237Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11238@itemize @bullet
11239@item
11240to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11241no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11242
11243@item
11244to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11245normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11246to detect program completion.
11247@end itemize
11248
11249In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11250development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11251
11252@node Hitachi ICE
11253@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11254
11255@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11256You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11257Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11258e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11259
11260@table @code
11261@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11262Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11263@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11264@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11265(for example, @samp{9600}).
11266
11267@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11268If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11269specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11270@end table
11271
11272@node Hitachi Special
11273@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11274
11275Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11276
11277@table @code
11278
11279@kindex set machine
11280@kindex show machine
11281@item set machine h8300
11282@itemx set machine h8300h
11283Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11284architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11285to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11286
11287@end table
11288
8e04817f
AC
11289@node H8/500
11290@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11291
11292@table @code
11293
8e04817f
AC
11294@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11295@cindex memory models, H8/500
11296@item set memory @var{mod}
11297@itemx show memory
11298Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11299@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11300memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11301@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11302
8e04817f 11303@end table
104c1213 11304
8e04817f
AC
11305@node i960
11306@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11307
8e04817f 11308@table @code
104c1213 11309
8e04817f
AC
11310@kindex target mon960
11311@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11312MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11313
8e04817f
AC
11314@kindex target nindy
11315@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11316An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11317the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11318@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11319
8e04817f
AC
11320@end table
11321
11322@cindex Nindy
11323@cindex i960
11324@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11325@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11326tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11327
11328@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11329@item
8e04817f
AC
11330Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11331Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11332
11333@item
8e04817f 11334By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11335
11336@item
8e04817f
AC
11337By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11338session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11339
11340@end itemize
11341
11342@cindex download to Nindy-960
11343With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11344downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11345@value{GDBN}.
11346
11347@menu
11348* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11349* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11350* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11351@end menu
11352
11353@node Nindy Startup
11354@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11355
11356If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11357options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11358reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11359
474c8240 11360@smallexample
8e04817f 11361Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11362@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11363
11364@noindent
11365Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11366identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11367simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11368with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11369use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11370
11371@node Nindy Options
11372@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11373
11374These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11375Nindy-960 board attached:
11376
11377@table @code
11378@item -r @var{port}
11379Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11380to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11381configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11382@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11383device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11384suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11385
11386@item -O
11387(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11388the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11389This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11390target architecture.
11391
11392@quotation
11393@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11394connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11395fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11396attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11397this process with an interrupt.
11398@end quotation
11399
11400@item -brk
11401Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11402system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11403
11404@quotation
11405@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11406requires; it only works with a few boards.
11407@end quotation
11408@end table
11409
11410The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11411port.
11412
11413@c @group
11414@node Nindy Reset
11415@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11416
11417@table @code
11418@item reset
11419@kindex reset
11420For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11421system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11422circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11423a break is detected.
11424@end table
11425@c @end group
11426
11427@node M32R/D
11428@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11429
11430@table @code
11431
11432@kindex target m32r
11433@item target m32r @var{dev}
11434Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11435
11436@end table
11437
11438@node M68K
11439@subsection M68k
11440
11441The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11442target command for the following ROM monitors.
11443
11444@table @code
11445
11446@kindex target abug
11447@item target abug @var{dev}
11448ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11449
11450@kindex target cpu32bug
11451@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11452CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11453
11454@kindex target dbug
11455@item target dbug @var{dev}
11456dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11457
11458@kindex target est
11459@item target est @var{dev}
11460EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11461
11462@kindex target rom68k
11463@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11464ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11465
11466@end table
11467
11468If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11469instead have only a single special target command:
11470
11471@table @code
11472
11473@kindex target es1800
11474@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11475ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11476
11477@end table
11478
11479[context?]
11480
11481@table @code
11482
11483@kindex target rombug
11484@item target rombug @var{dev}
11485ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11486
11487@end table
11488
11489@node M88K
11490@subsection M88K
11491
11492@table @code
11493
11494@kindex target bug
11495@item target bug @var{dev}
11496BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11497
11498@end table
11499
11500@node MIPS Embedded
11501@subsection MIPS Embedded
11502
11503@cindex MIPS boards
11504@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11505MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11506you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11507
8e04817f
AC
11508@need 1000
11509Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11510
8e04817f
AC
11511@table @code
11512@item target mips @var{port}
11513@kindex target mips @var{port}
11514To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11515name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11516command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11517the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11518been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11519download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11520
8e04817f
AC
11521For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11522port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11523debugger:
104c1213 11524
474c8240 11525@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11526host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11527@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11528(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11529(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11530(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11531@end smallexample
104c1213 11532
8e04817f
AC
11533@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11534On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11535connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11536concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11537@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11538
8e04817f
AC
11539@item target pmon @var{port}
11540@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11541PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11542
8e04817f
AC
11543@item target ddb @var{port}
11544@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11545NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11546
8e04817f
AC
11547@item target lsi @var{port}
11548@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11549LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11550
8e04817f
AC
11551@kindex target r3900
11552@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11553Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11554
8e04817f
AC
11555@kindex target array
11556@item target array @var{dev}
11557Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11558
8e04817f 11559@end table
104c1213 11560
104c1213 11561
8e04817f
AC
11562@noindent
11563@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11564
8e04817f
AC
11565@table @code
11566@item set processor @var{args}
11567@itemx show processor
11568@kindex set processor @var{args}
11569@kindex show processor
11570Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11571processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11572For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11573to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11574Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11575is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11576@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11577
8e04817f
AC
11578@item set mipsfpu double
11579@itemx set mipsfpu single
11580@itemx set mipsfpu none
11581@itemx show mipsfpu
11582@kindex set mipsfpu
11583@kindex show mipsfpu
11584@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11585@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11586If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11587coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11588need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11589file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11590functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11591@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11592functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11593with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11594processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11595double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11596@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11597
8e04817f
AC
11598In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11599floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11600and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11601
8e04817f
AC
11602As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11603@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11604
8e04817f
AC
11605@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11606@itemx show remotedebug
11607@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11608@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11609@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11610@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11611@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11612@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11613You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11614by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11615@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11616to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11617at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11618
8e04817f
AC
11619@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11620@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11621@itemx show timeout
11622@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11623@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11624@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11625@kindex set timeout
11626@kindex show timeout
11627@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11628@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11629You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11630remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11631default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11632waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11633retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11634You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11635retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11636@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11637
8e04817f
AC
11638The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11639is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11640forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11641to run before stopping.
11642@end table
104c1213 11643
8e04817f
AC
11644@node PowerPC
11645@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11646
11647@table @code
104c1213 11648
8e04817f
AC
11649@kindex target dink32
11650@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11651DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11652
8e04817f
AC
11653@kindex target ppcbug
11654@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11655@kindex target ppcbug1
11656@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11657PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11658
8e04817f
AC
11659@kindex target sds
11660@item target sds @var{dev}
11661SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11662
11663@end table
11664
11665@node PA
11666@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11667
11668@table @code
11669
8e04817f
AC
11670@kindex target op50n
11671@item target op50n @var{dev}
11672OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11673
11674@kindex target w89k
11675@item target w89k @var{dev}
11676W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11677
11678@end table
11679
8e04817f
AC
11680@node SH
11681@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11682
11683@table @code
11684
8e04817f
AC
11685@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11686@item target hms @var{dev}
11687A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11688commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11689the communications speed used.
104c1213 11690
8e04817f
AC
11691@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11692@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11693E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11694
8e04817f
AC
11695@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11696@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11697@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11698@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11699Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11700
8e04817f 11701@end table
104c1213 11702
8e04817f
AC
11703@node Sparclet
11704@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11705
8e04817f
AC
11706@cindex Sparclet
11707
11708@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11709Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11710@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11711both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11712@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11713
8e04817f
AC
11714@table @code
11715@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11716@kindex remotetimeout
11717@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11718This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11719seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11720@end table
11721
8e04817f
AC
11722@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11723When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11724information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11725load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11726@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11727
474c8240 11728@smallexample
8e04817f 11729sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 11730@end smallexample
104c1213 11731
8e04817f 11732You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11733
474c8240 11734@smallexample
8e04817f 11735sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 11736@end smallexample
104c1213 11737
8e04817f
AC
11738@cindex running, on Sparclet
11739Once you have set
11740your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11741run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11742(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11743
8e04817f
AC
11744@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11745
474c8240 11746@smallexample
8e04817f 11747(gdbslet)
474c8240 11748@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11749
11750@menu
8e04817f
AC
11751* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11752* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11753* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11754* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11755@end menu
11756
8e04817f
AC
11757@node Sparclet File
11758@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 11759
8e04817f 11760The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 11761
474c8240 11762@smallexample
8e04817f 11763(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 11764@end smallexample
104c1213 11765
8e04817f
AC
11766@need 1000
11767@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11768@value{GDBN} locates
11769the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11770path.
11771If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11772files will be searched as well.
11773@value{GDBN} locates
11774the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11775path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11776If it fails
11777to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 11778
474c8240 11779@smallexample
8e04817f 11780prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11781@end smallexample
104c1213 11782
8e04817f
AC
11783When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11784the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11785@code{target} command again.
104c1213 11786
8e04817f
AC
11787@node Sparclet Connection
11788@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 11789
8e04817f
AC
11790The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11791To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 11792
474c8240 11793@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11794(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11795Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11796main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 11797@end smallexample
104c1213 11798
8e04817f
AC
11799@need 750
11800@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11801
474c8240 11802@smallexample
8e04817f 11803Connected to ttya.
474c8240 11804@end smallexample
104c1213 11805
8e04817f
AC
11806@node Sparclet Download
11807@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 11808
8e04817f
AC
11809@cindex download to Sparclet
11810Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11811you can use the @value{GDBN}
11812@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11813The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11814command.
11815Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11816address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11817offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11818of each of the file's sections.
11819For instance, if the program
11820@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11821and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11822
474c8240 11823@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11824(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11825Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 11826@end smallexample
104c1213 11827
8e04817f
AC
11828If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11829to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11830to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11831
11832@node Sparclet Execution
11833@subsubsection Running and debugging
11834
11835@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11836You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11837commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11838manual for the list of commands.
11839
474c8240 11840@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11841(gdbslet) b main
11842Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11843(gdbslet) run
11844Starting program: prog
11845Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
118463 char *symarg = 0;
11847(gdbslet) step
118484 char *execarg = "hello!";
11849(gdbslet)
474c8240 11850@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11851
11852@node Sparclite
11853@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11854
11855@table @code
11856
8e04817f
AC
11857@kindex target sparclite
11858@item target sparclite @var{dev}
11859Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11860You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11861For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11862remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
11863
11864@end table
11865
8e04817f
AC
11866@node ST2000
11867@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 11868
8e04817f
AC
11869@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11870STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 11871
8e04817f
AC
11872To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11873manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 11874
474c8240 11875@smallexample
8e04817f 11876target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 11877@end smallexample
104c1213 11878
8e04817f
AC
11879@noindent
11880to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11881the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11882ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11883connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11884concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11885
8e04817f
AC
11886The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11887this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11888would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11889(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11890available on your host computer.
11891@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11892@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 11893
8e04817f
AC
11894@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11895These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11896environment:
104c1213 11897
8e04817f
AC
11898@table @code
11899@item st2000 @var{command}
11900@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11901@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11902@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11903Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11904manual for available commands.
104c1213 11905
8e04817f
AC
11906@item connect
11907@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11908Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11909you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11910sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11911@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11912@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
11913@end table
11914
8e04817f
AC
11915@node Z8000
11916@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 11917
8e04817f
AC
11918@cindex Z8000
11919@cindex simulator, Z8000
11920@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 11921
8e04817f
AC
11922When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11923a Z8000 simulator.
11924
11925For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11926unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11927segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11928appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 11929
8e04817f
AC
11930@table @code
11931@item target sim @var{args}
11932@kindex sim
11933@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11934Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11935options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
11936@end table
11937
8e04817f
AC
11938@noindent
11939After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11940CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11941@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11942to run your program, and so on.
11943
11944As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11945(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11946additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11947
11948@table @code
11949
8e04817f
AC
11950@item cycles
11951Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 11952
8e04817f
AC
11953@item insts
11954Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 11955
8e04817f
AC
11956@item time
11957Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 11958
8e04817f 11959@end table
104c1213 11960
8e04817f
AC
11961You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11962conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11963conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11964simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 11965
8e04817f
AC
11966@node Architectures
11967@section Architectures
104c1213 11968
8e04817f
AC
11969This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
11970all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 11971
8e04817f
AC
11972@menu
11973* A29K::
11974* Alpha::
11975* MIPS::
11976@end menu
104c1213 11977
8e04817f
AC
11978@node A29K
11979@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
11980
11981@table @code
104c1213 11982
8e04817f
AC
11983@kindex set rstack_high_address
11984@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11985@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11986@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11987On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
11988@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
11989extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11990stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11991memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11992this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11993the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11994address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11995hexadecimal.
104c1213 11996
8e04817f
AC
11997@kindex show rstack_high_address
11998@item show rstack_high_address
11999Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12000processors.
104c1213 12001
8e04817f 12002@end table
104c1213 12003
8e04817f
AC
12004@node Alpha
12005@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12006
8e04817f 12007See the following section.
104c1213 12008
8e04817f
AC
12009@node MIPS
12010@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12011
8e04817f
AC
12012@cindex stack on Alpha
12013@cindex stack on MIPS
12014@cindex Alpha stack
12015@cindex MIPS stack
12016Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12017sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12018find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12019
8e04817f
AC
12020@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12021To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12022@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12023you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12024commands:
104c1213 12025
8e04817f
AC
12026@table @code
12027@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12028@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12029Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12030search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12031default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12032larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12033and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12034
8e04817f
AC
12035@item show heuristic-fence-post
12036Display the current limit.
12037@end table
104c1213
JM
12038
12039@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12040These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12041for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12042
104c1213 12043
8e04817f
AC
12044@node Controlling GDB
12045@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12046
12047You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12048@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12049data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12050described here.
12051
12052@menu
12053* Prompt:: Prompt
12054* Editing:: Command editing
12055* History:: Command history
12056* Screen Size:: Screen size
12057* Numbers:: Numbers
12058* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12059* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12060@end menu
12061
12062@node Prompt
12063@section Prompt
104c1213 12064
8e04817f 12065@cindex prompt
104c1213 12066
8e04817f
AC
12067@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12068called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12069can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12070instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12071the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12072which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12073
8e04817f
AC
12074@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12075prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12076or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12077
8e04817f
AC
12078@table @code
12079@kindex set prompt
12080@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12081Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12082
8e04817f
AC
12083@kindex show prompt
12084@item show prompt
12085Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12086@end table
12087
8e04817f
AC
12088@node Editing
12089@section Command editing
12090@cindex readline
12091@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12092
8e04817f
AC
12093@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12094@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12095command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12096or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12097substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12098debugging sessions.
104c1213 12099
8e04817f
AC
12100You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12101command @code{set}.
104c1213 12102
8e04817f
AC
12103@table @code
12104@kindex set editing
12105@cindex editing
12106@item set editing
12107@itemx set editing on
12108Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12109
8e04817f
AC
12110@item set editing off
12111Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12112
8e04817f
AC
12113@kindex show editing
12114@item show editing
12115Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12116@end table
12117
8e04817f
AC
12118@node History
12119@section Command history
12120
12121@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12122debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12123happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12124history facility.
104c1213
JM
12125
12126@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12127@cindex history substitution
12128@cindex history file
12129@kindex set history filename
12130@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12131@item set history filename @var{fname}
12132Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12133This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12134list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12135exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12136the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12137to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12138@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12139is not set.
104c1213 12140
8e04817f
AC
12141@cindex history save
12142@kindex set history save
12143@item set history save
12144@itemx set history save on
12145Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12146@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12147
8e04817f
AC
12148@item set history save off
12149Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12150
8e04817f
AC
12151@cindex history size
12152@kindex set history size
12153@item set history size @var{size}
12154Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12155This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12156@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12157@end table
12158
8e04817f
AC
12159@cindex history expansion
12160History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12161@ifset have-readline-appendices
12162@xref{Event Designators}.
12163@end ifset
12164
12165Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12166is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12167@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12168follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12169a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12170history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12171@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12172
12173The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12174
12175@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12176@kindex set history expansion
12177@item set history expansion on
12178@itemx set history expansion
12179Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12180
8e04817f
AC
12181@item set history expansion off
12182Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12183
8e04817f
AC
12184The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12185editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12186or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12187@ifset have-readline-appendices
12188@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12189@end ifset
104c1213 12190
8e04817f
AC
12191@c @group
12192@kindex show history
12193@item show history
12194@itemx show history filename
12195@itemx show history save
12196@itemx show history size
12197@itemx show history expansion
12198These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12199@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12200@c @end group
12201@end table
12202
12203@table @code
12204@kindex shows
12205@item show commands
12206Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12207
8e04817f
AC
12208@item show commands @var{n}
12209Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12210
12211@item show commands +
12212Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12213@end table
12214
8e04817f
AC
12215@node Screen Size
12216@section Screen size
12217@cindex size of screen
12218@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12219
8e04817f
AC
12220Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12221information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12222@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12223output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12224to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12225determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12226printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12227rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12228
12229Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12230driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12231together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12232@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12233you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12234width} commands:
12235
12236@table @code
12237@kindex set height
12238@kindex set width
12239@kindex show width
12240@kindex show height
12241@item set height @var{lpp}
12242@itemx show height
12243@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12244@itemx show width
12245These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12246a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12247commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12248
8e04817f
AC
12249If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12250output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12251file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12252
8e04817f
AC
12253Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12254from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12255@end table
12256
8e04817f
AC
12257@node Numbers
12258@section Numbers
12259@cindex number representation
12260@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12261
8e04817f
AC
12262You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12263@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12264@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12265begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12266default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12267numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12268change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12269radix} command.
104c1213 12270
8e04817f
AC
12271@table @code
12272@kindex set input-radix
12273@item set input-radix @var{base}
12274Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12275for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12276specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12277example, any of
104c1213 12278
8e04817f
AC
12279@smallexample
12280set radix 012
12281set radix 10.
12282set radix 0xa
12283@end smallexample
104c1213 12284
8e04817f
AC
12285@noindent
12286sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12287leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12288
8e04817f
AC
12289@kindex set output-radix
12290@item set output-radix @var{base}
12291Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12292for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12293specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12294
8e04817f
AC
12295@kindex show input-radix
12296@item show input-radix
12297Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12298
8e04817f
AC
12299@kindex show output-radix
12300@item show output-radix
12301Display the current default base for numeric display.
12302@end table
104c1213 12303
8e04817f
AC
12304@node Messages/Warnings
12305@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12306
8e04817f
AC
12307By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12308running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12309command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12310internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12311
8e04817f
AC
12312Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12313which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12314see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12315
8e04817f
AC
12316@table @code
12317@kindex set verbose
12318@item set verbose on
12319Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12320
8e04817f
AC
12321@item set verbose off
12322Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12323
8e04817f
AC
12324@kindex show verbose
12325@item show verbose
12326Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12327@end table
104c1213 12328
8e04817f
AC
12329By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12330object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12331find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12332symbol files}).
104c1213 12333
8e04817f 12334@table @code
104c1213 12335
8e04817f
AC
12336@kindex set complaints
12337@item set complaints @var{limit}
12338Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12339unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12340@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12341to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12342
8e04817f
AC
12343@kindex show complaints
12344@item show complaints
12345Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12346
8e04817f 12347@end table
104c1213 12348
8e04817f
AC
12349By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12350lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12351you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12352
474c8240 12353@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12354(@value{GDBP}) run
12355The program being debugged has been started already.
12356Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12357@end smallexample
104c1213 12358
8e04817f
AC
12359If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12360commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12361
8e04817f 12362@table @code
104c1213 12363
8e04817f
AC
12364@kindex set confirm
12365@cindex flinching
12366@cindex confirmation
12367@cindex stupid questions
12368@item set confirm off
12369Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12370
8e04817f
AC
12371@item set confirm on
12372Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12373
8e04817f
AC
12374@kindex show confirm
12375@item show confirm
12376Displays state of confirmation requests.
12377
12378@end table
104c1213 12379
8e04817f
AC
12380@node Debugging Output
12381@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12382@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12383@kindex set debug arch
12384@item set debug arch
12385Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12386@kindex show debug arch
12387@item show debug arch
12388Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12389@kindex set debug event
12390@item set debug event
12391Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12392default is off.
12393@kindex show debug event
12394@item show debug event
12395Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12396info.
12397@kindex set debug expression
12398@item set debug expression
12399Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12400default is off.
12401@kindex show debug expression
12402@item show debug expression
12403Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12404debugging info.
12405@kindex set debug overload
12406@item set debug overload
12407Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12408info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12409is off.
12410@kindex show debug overload
12411@item show debug overload
12412Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12413debugging info.
12414@kindex set debug remote
12415@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12416@cindex serial connections, debugging
12417@item set debug remote
12418Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12419the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12420@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12421@kindex show debug remote
12422@item show debug remote
12423Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12424@kindex set debug serial
12425@item set debug serial
12426Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12427default is off.
12428@kindex show debug serial
12429@item show debug serial
12430Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12431info.
12432@kindex set debug target
12433@item set debug target
12434Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12435includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12436default is off.
12437@kindex show debug target
12438@item show debug target
12439Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12440info.
12441@kindex set debug varobj
12442@item set debug varobj
12443Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12444info. The default is off.
12445@kindex show debug varobj
12446@item show debug varobj
12447Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12448debugging info.
12449@end table
104c1213 12450
8e04817f
AC
12451@node Sequences
12452@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12453
8e04817f
AC
12454Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12455command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12456commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12457files.
104c1213 12458
8e04817f
AC
12459@menu
12460* Define:: User-defined commands
12461* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12462* Command Files:: Command files
12463* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12464@end menu
104c1213 12465
8e04817f
AC
12466@node Define
12467@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12468
8e04817f
AC
12469@cindex user-defined command
12470A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12471which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12472@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12473separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12474via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12475
8e04817f
AC
12476@smallexample
12477define adder
12478 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12479@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12480
12481@noindent
8e04817f 12482To execute the command use:
104c1213 12483
8e04817f
AC
12484@smallexample
12485adder 1 2 3
12486@end smallexample
104c1213 12487
8e04817f
AC
12488@noindent
12489This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12490its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12491reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12492functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12493
12494@table @code
104c1213 12495
8e04817f
AC
12496@kindex define
12497@item define @var{commandname}
12498Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12499by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12500
8e04817f
AC
12501The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12502which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12503commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12504
8e04817f
AC
12505@kindex if
12506@kindex else
12507@item if
12508Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12509It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12510only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12511There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12512by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12513was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12514
8e04817f
AC
12515@kindex while
12516@item while
12517The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12518which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12519execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12520The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12521evaluates to true.
104c1213 12522
8e04817f
AC
12523@kindex document
12524@item document @var{commandname}
12525Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12526accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12527defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12528reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12529After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12530@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12531
8e04817f
AC
12532You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12533documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12534does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12535
8e04817f
AC
12536@kindex help user-defined
12537@item help user-defined
12538List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12539(if any) for each.
104c1213 12540
8e04817f
AC
12541@kindex show user
12542@item show user
12543@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12544Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12545not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12546definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12547
20f01a46
DH
12548@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12549@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12550@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12551@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12552The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12553levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12554infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12555
104c1213
JM
12556@end table
12557
8e04817f
AC
12558When user-defined commands are executed, the
12559commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12560stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12561
8e04817f
AC
12562If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12563without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12564commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12565messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12566
8e04817f
AC
12567@node Hooks
12568@section User-defined command hooks
12569@cindex command hooks
12570@cindex hooks, for commands
12571@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12572
8e04817f
AC
12573@kindex hook
12574@kindex hook-
12575You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12576command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12577command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12578before that command.
104c1213 12579
8e04817f
AC
12580@cindex hooks, post-command
12581@kindex hookpost
12582@kindex hookpost-
12583A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12584Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12585@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12586that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12587pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12588
8e04817f
AC
12589It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12590occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12591
8e04817f
AC
12592@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12593@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12594
8e04817f
AC
12595@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12596In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12597(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12598execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12599displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12600
8e04817f
AC
12601For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12602single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12603you could define:
104c1213 12604
474c8240 12605@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12606define hook-stop
12607handle SIGALRM nopass
12608end
104c1213 12609
8e04817f
AC
12610define hook-run
12611handle SIGALRM pass
12612end
104c1213 12613
8e04817f
AC
12614define hook-continue
12615handle SIGLARM pass
12616end
474c8240 12617@end smallexample
104c1213 12618
8e04817f
AC
12619As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12620command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12621you could define:
104c1213 12622
474c8240 12623@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12624define hook-echo
12625echo <<<---
12626end
104c1213 12627
8e04817f
AC
12628define hookpost-echo
12629echo --->>>\n
12630end
104c1213 12631
8e04817f
AC
12632(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12633<<<---Hello World--->>>
12634(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12635
474c8240 12636@end smallexample
104c1213 12637
8e04817f
AC
12638You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12639not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12640name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12641@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12642@c or not?
12643If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12644@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12645(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12646
8e04817f
AC
12647If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12648get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12649
8e04817f
AC
12650@node Command Files
12651@section Command files
c906108c 12652
8e04817f
AC
12653@cindex command files
12654A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12655commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12656An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12657the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12658
8e04817f
AC
12659@cindex init file
12660@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12661@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12662When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12663@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12664port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12665limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12666During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12667
8e04817f
AC
12668@enumerate
12669@item
12670Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12671DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12672@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12673
8e04817f
AC
12674@item
12675Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12676
8e04817f
AC
12677@item
12678Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12679
8e04817f
AC
12680@item
12681Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12682@end enumerate
c906108c 12683
8e04817f
AC
12684The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12685complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12686and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12687option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12688
8e04817f
AC
12689@cindex init file name
12690On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12691different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12692form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12693different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12694environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12695
8e04817f
AC
12696@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12697@itemize @bullet
12698@item
12699VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12700
8e04817f
AC
12701@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12702@item
12703OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12704
8e04817f
AC
12705@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12706@item
12707ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12708@end itemize
c906108c 12709
8e04817f
AC
12710You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12711@code{source} command:
c906108c 12712
8e04817f
AC
12713@table @code
12714@kindex source
12715@item source @var{filename}
12716Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12717@end table
12718
8e04817f
AC
12719The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12720printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12721of the command file.
c906108c 12722
8e04817f
AC
12723Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12724without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12725normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12726when called from command files.
c906108c 12727
8e04817f
AC
12728@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12729mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12730standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12731not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12732the next command.
c906108c 12733
474c8240 12734@smallexample
8e04817f 12735gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 12736@end smallexample
c906108c 12737
8e04817f
AC
12738(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12739will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
12740would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 12741
8e04817f
AC
12742@node Output
12743@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 12744
8e04817f
AC
12745During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12746@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12747explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12748describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12749want.
c906108c
SS
12750
12751@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12752@kindex echo
12753@item echo @var{text}
12754@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12755@c because it is not in ANSI.
12756Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12757@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12758newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12759In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12760by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12761string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12762trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12763To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12764@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 12765
8e04817f
AC
12766A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12767the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 12768
474c8240 12769@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12770echo This is some text\n\
12771which is continued\n\
12772onto several lines.\n
474c8240 12773@end smallexample
c906108c 12774
8e04817f 12775produces the same output as
c906108c 12776
474c8240 12777@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12778echo This is some text\n
12779echo which is continued\n
12780echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 12781@end smallexample
c906108c 12782
8e04817f
AC
12783@kindex output
12784@item output @var{expression}
12785Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12786newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12787value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12788on expressions.
c906108c 12789
8e04817f
AC
12790@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12791Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12792the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12793formats}, for more information.
c906108c 12794
8e04817f
AC
12795@kindex printf
12796@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12797Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12798@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12799either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12800@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12801subroutine
12802@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12803@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12804@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12805@c supported.
c906108c 12806
474c8240 12807@smallexample
8e04817f 12808printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 12809@end smallexample
c906108c 12810
8e04817f 12811For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 12812
8e04817f
AC
12813@smallexample
12814printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12815@end smallexample
c906108c 12816
8e04817f
AC
12817The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12818string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12819letter.
c906108c
SS
12820@end table
12821
8e04817f
AC
12822@node TUI
12823@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
12824@cindex TUI
c906108c 12825
8e04817f
AC
12826@menu
12827* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
12828* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
12829* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
12830* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
12831@end menu
c906108c 12832
8e04817f
AC
12833The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
12834is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
12835to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
12836and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
12837The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
12838with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 12839
8e04817f
AC
12840@node TUI Overview
12841@section TUI overview
c906108c 12842
8e04817f
AC
12843The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
12844@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 12845
8e04817f
AC
12846@itemize @bullet
12847@item
12848A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
12849windows on the terminal.
c906108c 12850
8e04817f
AC
12851@item
12852A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
12853the TUI.
12854@end itemize
c906108c 12855
8e04817f
AC
12856In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
12857on the terminal:
c906108c 12858
8e04817f
AC
12859@table @emph
12860@item command
12861This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
12862prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
12863managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
12864window is always visible.
c906108c 12865
8e04817f
AC
12866@item source
12867The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
12868line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
12869The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
12870active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
c906108c 12871
8e04817f
AC
12872@item assembly
12873The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 12874
8e04817f
AC
12875@item register
12876This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
12877a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
12878changed are highlighted.
c906108c 12879
c906108c
SS
12880@end table
12881
8e04817f
AC
12882The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
12883and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
12884changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
12885These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
12886layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
12887The following layouts are available:
c906108c 12888
8e04817f
AC
12889@itemize @bullet
12890@item
12891source
2df3850c 12892
8e04817f
AC
12893@item
12894assembly
12895
12896@item
12897source and assembly
12898
12899@item
12900source and registers
c906108c 12901
8e04817f
AC
12902@item
12903assembly and registers
2df3850c 12904
8e04817f 12905@end itemize
c906108c 12906
8e04817f
AC
12907@node TUI Keys
12908@section TUI Key Bindings
12909@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 12910
8e04817f
AC
12911The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
12912(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
12913They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
12914directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
12915are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 12916
8e04817f
AC
12917@table @kbd
12918@kindex C-x C-a
12919@item C-x C-a
12920@kindex C-x a
12921@itemx C-x a
12922@kindex C-x A
12923@itemx C-x A
12924Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
12925the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
12926its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
12927mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
12928The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 12929
8e04817f
AC
12930@kindex C-x 1
12931@item C-x 1
12932Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
12933either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
12934is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 12935
8e04817f 12936Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 12937
8e04817f
AC
12938@kindex C-x 2
12939@item C-x 2
12940Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
12941layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
12942When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
12943previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 12944
8e04817f 12945Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 12946
c906108c
SS
12947@end table
12948
8e04817f 12949The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 12950
8e04817f
AC
12951@table @key
12952@kindex PgUp
12953@item PgUp
12954Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956@kindex PgDn
12957@item PgDn
12958Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 12959
8e04817f
AC
12960@kindex Up
12961@item Up
12962Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 12963
8e04817f
AC
12964@kindex Down
12965@item Down
12966Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 12967
8e04817f
AC
12968@kindex Left
12969@item Left
12970Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 12971
8e04817f
AC
12972@kindex Right
12973@item Right
12974Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 12975
8e04817f
AC
12976@kindex C-L
12977@item C-L
12978Refresh the screen.
c906108c 12979
8e04817f 12980@end table
c906108c 12981
8e04817f
AC
12982In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
12983for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
12984necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
12985@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
12986
12987@node TUI Commands
12988@section TUI specific commands
12989@cindex TUI commands
12990
12991The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
12992These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
12993the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
12994is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
12995in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
12996
12997@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12998@item layout next
12999@kindex layout next
13000Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13001
8e04817f
AC
13002@item layout prev
13003@kindex layout prev
13004Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13005
8e04817f
AC
13006@item layout src
13007@kindex layout src
13008Display the source window only.
c906108c 13009
8e04817f
AC
13010@item layout asm
13011@kindex layout asm
13012Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13013
8e04817f
AC
13014@item layout split
13015@kindex layout split
13016Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13017
8e04817f
AC
13018@item layout regs
13019@kindex layout regs
13020Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13021
13022@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13023@kindex focus
13024Set the focus to the named window.
13025This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13026can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13027
8e04817f
AC
13028@item refresh
13029@kindex refresh
13030Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13031
8e04817f
AC
13032@item update
13033@kindex update
13034Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13035
8e04817f
AC
13036@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13037@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13038@kindex winheight
13039Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13040lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13041decrease it.
2df3850c 13042
c906108c
SS
13043@end table
13044
8e04817f
AC
13045@node TUI Configuration
13046@section TUI configuration variables
13047@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13048
8e04817f
AC
13049The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13050appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13051
8e04817f
AC
13052@table @code
13053@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13054@kindex set tui border-kind
13055Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13056The possible values are the following:
13057@table @code
13058@item space
13059Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13060
8e04817f
AC
13061@item ascii
13062Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13063
8e04817f
AC
13064@item acs
13065Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13066drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13067
8e04817f 13068@end table
c78b4128 13069
8e04817f
AC
13070@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13071@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13072Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13073The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13074@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13075
8e04817f
AC
13076@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13077@kindex set tui border-mode
13078Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13079The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13080@table @code
13081@item normal
13082Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13083
8e04817f
AC
13084@item standout
13085Use standout mode.
c906108c 13086
8e04817f
AC
13087@item reverse
13088Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13089
8e04817f
AC
13090@item half
13091Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13092
8e04817f
AC
13093@item half-standout
13094Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13095
8e04817f
AC
13096@item bold
13097Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13098
8e04817f
AC
13099@item bold-standout
13100Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13101
8e04817f 13102@end table
c78b4128 13103
8e04817f 13104@end table
c78b4128 13105
8e04817f
AC
13106@node Emacs
13107@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13108
8e04817f
AC
13109@cindex Emacs
13110@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13111A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13112edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13113@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13114
8e04817f
AC
13115To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13116executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13117@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13118created Emacs buffer.
13119@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13120
8e04817f
AC
13121Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13122things:
c906108c 13123
8e04817f
AC
13124@itemize @bullet
13125@item
13126All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13127@end itemize
c906108c 13128
8e04817f
AC
13129This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13130and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13131
8e04817f
AC
13132This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13133commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13134in this way.
bf0184be 13135
8e04817f
AC
13136All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13137with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13138way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13139stop.
bf0184be 13140
8e04817f 13141@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13142@item
8e04817f
AC
13143@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13144@end itemize
bf0184be 13145
8e04817f
AC
13146Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13147source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13148left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13149source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13150and the source.
bf0184be 13151
8e04817f
AC
13152Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13153usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13154
8e04817f
AC
13155@quotation
13156@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13157current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13158the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13159appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13160environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13161session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13162back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13163avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13164your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13165@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13166
8e04817f
AC
13167A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13168switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13169@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13170@end quotation
13171
13172By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13173you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13174several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13175Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13176
474c8240 13177@smallexample
8e04817f 13178(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13179@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13180
13181@noindent
13182(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13183in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13184``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13185
13186In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13187addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13188
8e04817f
AC
13189@table @kbd
13190@item C-h m
13191Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13192
8e04817f
AC
13193@item M-s
13194Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13195update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13196
8e04817f
AC
13197@item M-n
13198Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13199calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13200to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13201
8e04817f
AC
13202@item M-i
13203Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13204display window accordingly.
c906108c 13205
8e04817f
AC
13206@item M-x gdb-nexti
13207Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13208display window accordingly.
c906108c 13209
8e04817f
AC
13210@item C-c C-f
13211Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13212@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13213
8e04817f
AC
13214@item M-c
13215Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13216command.
b433d00b 13217
8e04817f 13218@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13219
8e04817f
AC
13220@item M-u
13221Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13222(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13223like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13224
8e04817f 13225@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13226
8e04817f
AC
13227@item M-d
13228Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13229@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13230
8e04817f 13231@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13232
8e04817f
AC
13233@item C-x &
13234Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13235of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13236around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13237then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13238argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13239
8e04817f
AC
13240You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13241@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13242otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13243inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13244wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13245list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13246formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13247is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13248@end table
c906108c 13249
8e04817f
AC
13250In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13251tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13252
8e04817f
AC
13253If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13254it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13255request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13256the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13257frame.
c906108c 13258
8e04817f
AC
13259The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13260which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13261the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13262communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13263delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13264to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13265
8e04817f
AC
13266@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13267@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13268@ignore
13269@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13270@kindex Epoch
13271@kindex inspect
c906108c 13272
8e04817f
AC
13273Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13274called the @code{epoch}
13275environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13276@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13277each value is printed in its own window.
13278@end ignore
c906108c 13279
8e04817f
AC
13280@include annotate.texi
13281@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13282
8e04817f
AC
13283@node GDB Bugs
13284@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13285@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13286@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13287
8e04817f 13288Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13289
8e04817f
AC
13290Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13291may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13292the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13293reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13294
8e04817f
AC
13295In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13296information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13297
13298@menu
8e04817f
AC
13299* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13300* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13301@end menu
13302
8e04817f
AC
13303@node Bug Criteria
13304@section Have you found a bug?
13305@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13306
8e04817f 13307If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13308
13309@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13310@cindex fatal signal
13311@cindex debugger crash
13312@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13313@item
8e04817f
AC
13314If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13315@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13316
13317@cindex error on valid input
13318@item
13319If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13320bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13321somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13322
8e04817f 13323@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13324@item
8e04817f
AC
13325If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13326that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13327``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13328for traditional practice''.
13329
13330@item
13331If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13332for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13333@end itemize
13334
8e04817f
AC
13335@node Bug Reporting
13336@section How to report bugs
13337@cindex bug reports
13338@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13339
13340A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13341If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13342contact that organization first.
13343
13344You can find contact information for many support companies and
13345individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13346distribution.
13347@c should add a web page ref...
13348
129188f6
AC
13349In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13350@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13351@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13352page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13353be used.
8e04817f
AC
13354
13355@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13356@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13357not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13358@samp{bug-gdb}.
13359
13360The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13361serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13362the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13363newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13364problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13365path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13366we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13367bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13368
8e04817f
AC
13369The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13370@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13371fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13372
8e04817f
AC
13373Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13374problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13375assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13376Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13377stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13378name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13379of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13380the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13381easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13382
8e04817f
AC
13383Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13384bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13385you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13386self-contained.
c4555f82 13387
8e04817f
AC
13388Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13389bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13390@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13391bugs properly.
13392
13393To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13394
13395@itemize @bullet
13396@item
8e04817f
AC
13397The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13398with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13399version}.
c4555f82 13400
8e04817f
AC
13401Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13402the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13403
13404@item
8e04817f
AC
13405The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13406version number.
c4555f82
SC
13407
13408@item
8e04817f
AC
13409What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13410``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13411
13412@item
8e04817f
AC
13413What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13414debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13415C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13416information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13417compilers.
c4555f82 13418
8e04817f
AC
13419@item
13420The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13421observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13422you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13423Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13424
8e04817f
AC
13425If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13426and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13427
8e04817f
AC
13428@item
13429A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13430reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13431
8e04817f
AC
13432@item
13433A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13434incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13435
8e04817f
AC
13436Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13437will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13438not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13439a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13440
8e04817f
AC
13441Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13442say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13443copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13444the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13445crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13446ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13447us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13448to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13449
8e04817f
AC
13450@item
13451If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13452diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13453it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13454
8e04817f
AC
13455The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13456sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13457
8e04817f 13458@end itemize
c4555f82 13459
8e04817f 13460Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13461
8e04817f
AC
13462@itemize @bullet
13463@item
13464A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13465
8e04817f
AC
13466Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13467which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13468changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13469
8e04817f
AC
13470This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13471will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13472with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13473We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13474
8e04817f
AC
13475Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13476of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13477output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13478less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13479
8e04817f
AC
13480However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13481report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13482
8e04817f
AC
13483@item
13484A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13485
8e04817f
AC
13486A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13487the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13488a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13489to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13490
8e04817f
AC
13491Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13492construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13493through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13494to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13495
8e04817f
AC
13496And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13497patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13498help us to understand.
c4555f82 13499
8e04817f
AC
13500@item
13501A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13502
8e04817f
AC
13503Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13504things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13505@end itemize
c4555f82 13506
8e04817f
AC
13507@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13508@c and consists of the two following files:
13509@c rluser.texinfo
13510@c inc-hist.texinfo
13511@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13512@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13513@include rluser.texinfo
13514@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13515
c4555f82 13516
8e04817f
AC
13517@node Formatting Documentation
13518@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13519
8e04817f
AC
13520@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13521@cindex reference card
13522The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13523for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13524subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13525@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13526release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13527you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13528
8e04817f
AC
13529The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13530can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13531
474c8240 13532@smallexample
8e04817f 13533make refcard.dvi
474c8240 13534@end smallexample
c4555f82 13535
8e04817f
AC
13536The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13537mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13538that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13539high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13540your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13541
8e04817f 13542@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13543
8e04817f
AC
13544All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13545distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13546a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13547on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13548formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13549and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13550
8e04817f
AC
13551@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13552version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13553file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13554subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13555necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13556but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13557Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13558@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13559
8e04817f
AC
13560If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13561Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13562@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13563
8e04817f
AC
13564If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13565@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13566version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13567
474c8240 13568@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13569cd gdb
13570make gdb.info
474c8240 13571@end smallexample
c4555f82 13572
8e04817f
AC
13573If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13574a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13575Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13576
8e04817f
AC
13577@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13578produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13579document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13580has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13581command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13582(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13583require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13584
8e04817f
AC
13585@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13586@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13587written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13588typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13589and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13590directory.
c4555f82 13591
8e04817f
AC
13592If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13593typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13594subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13595@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 13596
474c8240 13597@smallexample
8e04817f 13598make gdb.dvi
474c8240 13599@end smallexample
c4555f82 13600
8e04817f 13601Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 13602
8e04817f
AC
13603@node Installing GDB
13604@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13605@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13606@cindex installation
c4555f82 13607
8e04817f
AC
13608@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13609of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13610build the @code{gdb} program.
13611@iftex
13612@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13613@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13614look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13615installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13616@end iftex
c4555f82 13617
8e04817f
AC
13618The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13619@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13620appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 13621
8e04817f
AC
13622For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13623@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 13624
8e04817f
AC
13625@table @code
13626@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13627script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 13628
8e04817f
AC
13629@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13630the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 13631
8e04817f
AC
13632@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13633source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 13634
8e04817f
AC
13635@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13636@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 13637
8e04817f
AC
13638@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13639source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 13640
8e04817f
AC
13641@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13642source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 13643
8e04817f
AC
13644@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13645source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 13646
8e04817f
AC
13647@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13648source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 13649
8e04817f
AC
13650@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13651source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13652@end table
c906108c 13653
8e04817f
AC
13654The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13655from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13656this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 13657
8e04817f
AC
13658First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13659if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13660identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13661argument.
c906108c 13662
8e04817f 13663For example:
c906108c 13664
474c8240 13665@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13666cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13667./configure @var{host}
13668make
474c8240 13669@end smallexample
c906108c 13670
8e04817f
AC
13671@noindent
13672where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13673@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13674(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13675correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 13676
8e04817f
AC
13677Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13678@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13679libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13680binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 13681
8e04817f
AC
13682@need 750
13683@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13684system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13685shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 13686
474c8240 13687@smallexample
8e04817f 13688sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 13689@end smallexample
c906108c 13690
8e04817f
AC
13691If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13692directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13693@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13694creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13695you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13696
13697You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13698subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13699configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 13700
8e04817f
AC
13701For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13702the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 13703
474c8240 13704@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13705@group
13706cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13707../configure @var{host}
13708@end group
474c8240 13709@end smallexample
c906108c 13710
8e04817f
AC
13711You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13712However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13713the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13714that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13715let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 13716
8e04817f
AC
13717@menu
13718* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13719* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13720* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13721@end menu
c906108c 13722
8e04817f
AC
13723@node Separate Objdir
13724@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 13725
8e04817f
AC
13726If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13727you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13728host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13729allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13730rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13731handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13732@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13733program specified there.
c906108c 13734
8e04817f
AC
13735To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13736with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13737(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13738itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13739would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13740the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 13741
8e04817f
AC
13742For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13743separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 13744
474c8240 13745@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13746@group
13747cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13748mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13749cd ../gdb-sun4
13750../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13751make
13752@end group
474c8240 13753@end smallexample
c906108c 13754
8e04817f
AC
13755When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13756directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13757(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13758the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13759directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13760@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 13761
8e04817f
AC
13762One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13763directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13764@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13765programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
13766You specify a cross-debugging target by
13767giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 13768
8e04817f
AC
13769When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13770it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13771called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 13772
8e04817f
AC
13773The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13774directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13775directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13776directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13777will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 13778
8e04817f
AC
13779When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13780directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13781if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13782with each other.
c906108c 13783
8e04817f
AC
13784@node Config Names
13785@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 13786
8e04817f
AC
13787The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13788script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13789aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13790of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 13791
474c8240 13792@smallexample
8e04817f 13793@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 13794@end smallexample
c906108c 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13797or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13798option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 13799
8e04817f
AC
13800The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13801any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13802aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13803@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13804script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13805abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 13806
8e04817f
AC
13807@smallexample
13808% sh config.sub i386-linux
13809i386-pc-linux-gnu
13810% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13811alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13812% sh config.sub hp9k700
13813hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13814% sh config.sub sun4
13815sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13816% sh config.sub sun3
13817m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13818% sh config.sub i986v
13819Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13820@end smallexample
c906108c 13821
8e04817f
AC
13822@noindent
13823@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13824directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 13825
8e04817f
AC
13826@node Configure Options
13827@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 13828
8e04817f
AC
13829Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13830are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13831several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13832Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 13833
474c8240 13834@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13835configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13836 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13837 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13838 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13839 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13840 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13841 @var{host}
474c8240 13842@end smallexample
c906108c 13843
8e04817f
AC
13844@noindent
13845You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13846@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13847@samp{--}.
c906108c 13848
8e04817f
AC
13849@table @code
13850@item --help
13851Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 13852
8e04817f
AC
13853@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13854Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13855@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 13856
8e04817f
AC
13857@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13858Configure the source to install programs under directory
13859@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 13860
8e04817f
AC
13861@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13862@need 2000
13863@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13864@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13865@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13866Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13867@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13868build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13869directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13870the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13871directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13872the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13873@var{dirname}.
c906108c 13874
8e04817f
AC
13875@item --norecursion
13876Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13877propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 13878
8e04817f
AC
13879@item --target=@var{target}
13880Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13881@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13882programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 13883
8e04817f 13884There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 13885
8e04817f
AC
13886@item @var{host} @dots{}
13887Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 13888
8e04817f
AC
13889There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13890@end table
c906108c 13891
8e04817f
AC
13892There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13893needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 13894
8e04817f
AC
13895@node Maintenance Commands
13896@appendix Maintenance Commands
13897@cindex maintenance commands
13898@cindex internal commands
c906108c 13899
8e04817f
AC
13900In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
13901includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
13902These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 13903
8e04817f
AC
13904@table @code
13905@kindex maint info breakpoints
13906@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
13907Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
13908breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
13909internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
13910breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
13911is shown:
c906108c 13912
8e04817f
AC
13913@table @code
13914@item breakpoint
13915Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 13916
8e04817f
AC
13917@item watchpoint
13918Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 13919
8e04817f
AC
13920@item longjmp
13921Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
13922@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 13923
8e04817f
AC
13924@item longjmp resume
13925Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 13926
8e04817f
AC
13927@item until
13928Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 13929
8e04817f
AC
13930@item finish
13931Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 13932
8e04817f
AC
13933@item shlib events
13934Shared library events.
c906108c 13935
8e04817f 13936@end table
c906108c 13937
8e04817f 13938@end table
c906108c 13939
c906108c 13940
e0ce93ac 13941@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 13942@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 13943
8e04817f
AC
13944There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
13945protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
13946machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
13947recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13948
8e04817f
AC
13949In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
13950transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 13951
8e04817f
AC
13952@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
13953@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
13954@cindex remote serial protocol
13955All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
13956sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
13957@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
13958@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 13959
474c8240 13960@smallexample
8e04817f 13961@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 13962@end smallexample
8e04817f 13963@noindent
c906108c 13964
8e04817f
AC
13965@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
13966@noindent
13967The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
13968characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
13969eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 13970
8e04817f
AC
13971Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
13972specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 13973
474c8240 13974@smallexample
8e04817f 13975@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 13976@end smallexample
c906108c 13977
8e04817f
AC
13978@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
13979@noindent
13980That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
13981has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
13982since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 13983
8e04817f
AC
13984@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
13985When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
13986response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
13987the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
13988retransmission):
c906108c 13989
474c8240 13990@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13991<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
13992-> @code{+}
474c8240 13993@end smallexample
8e04817f 13994@noindent
53a5351d 13995
8e04817f
AC
13996The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
13997debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
13998the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
13999when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14000
8e04817f
AC
14001@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14002exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14003exceptions).
c906108c 14004
8e04817f
AC
14005Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14006@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14007HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14008
8e04817f
AC
14009Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14010@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14011would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14012
8e04817f
AC
14013Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14014means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14015which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14016@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14017where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14018characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14019value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14020
8e04817f
AC
14021Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14022loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14023character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14024
8e04817f 14025So:
474c8240 14026@smallexample
8e04817f 14027"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14028@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14029@noindent
14030means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14031
8e04817f
AC
14032The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14033error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14034
8e04817f
AC
14035For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14036(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14037protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14038on that response.
c906108c 14039
8e04817f
AC
14040A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14041@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14042optional.
c906108c 14043
8e04817f
AC
14044Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
14045their corresponding response @var{data}:
14046@page
14047@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
14048@item Packet
14049@tab Request
14050@tab Description
c906108c 14051
8e04817f
AC
14052@item extended mode
14053@tab @code{!}
14054@tab
14055Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14056persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14057debugged.
c906108c 14058@item
8e04817f
AC
14059@tab reply @samp{OK}
14060@tab
14061The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
c906108c 14062
8e04817f
AC
14063@item last signal
14064@tab @code{?}
14065@tab
14066Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
14067and continue.
14068@item
14069@tab reply
14070@tab see below
c906108c
SS
14071
14072
8e04817f
AC
14073@item reserved
14074@tab @code{a}
14075@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14076
8e04817f
AC
14077@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14078@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
14079@tab
14080@item
14081@tab
14082@tab
14083Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14084specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14085See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
14086@item
14087@tab reply @code{OK}
14088@item
14089@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
c906108c 14090
8e04817f
AC
14091@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14092@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
14093@tab
14094Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
14095transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
14096transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
14097acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
14098to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
14099ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
14100specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
14101that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
14102happened.}
c906108c 14103
8e04817f
AC
14104@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14105@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
14106@tab
14107Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14108breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
14109@samp{z} packets.}
c906108c 14110
8e04817f
AC
14111@item continue
14112@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
14113@tab
14114@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14115current address.
14116@item
14117@tab reply
14118@tab see below
c906108c 14119
8e04817f
AC
14120@item continue with signal
14121@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14122@tab
14123Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14124@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14125@item
14126@tab reply
14127@tab see below
c906108c 14128
8e04817f
AC
14129@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14130@tab @code{d}
14131@tab
14132toggle debug flag.
c906108c 14133
8e04817f
AC
14134@item detach
14135@tab @code{D}
14136@tab
14137Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
14138@value{GDBN} disconnects.
14139@item
14140@tab reply @emph{no response}
14141@tab
14142@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
c906108c 14143
8e04817f
AC
14144@item reserved
14145@tab @code{e}
14146@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14147
8e04817f
AC
14148@item reserved
14149@tab @code{E}
14150@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14151
8e04817f
AC
14152@item reserved
14153@tab @code{f}
14154@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14155
8e04817f
AC
14156@item reserved
14157@tab @code{F}
14158@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14159
8e04817f
AC
14160@item read registers
14161@tab @code{g}
14162@tab Read general registers.
14163@item
14164@tab reply @var{XX...}
14165@tab
14166Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14167with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14168each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14169determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
14170@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14171@code{g} packets is specified below.
14172@item
14173@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
14174@tab for an error.
c906108c 14175
8e04817f
AC
14176@item write regs
14177@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
14178@tab
14179See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
14180@item
14181@tab reply @code{OK}
14182@tab for success
14183@item
14184@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14185@tab for an error
c906108c 14186
8e04817f
AC
14187@item reserved
14188@tab @code{h}
14189@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14190
8e04817f
AC
14191@item set thread
14192@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
14193@tab
14194Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14195@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
14196continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
14197thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
14198@item
14199@tab reply @code{OK}
14200@tab for success
14201@item
14202@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14203@tab for an error
c906108c 14204
8e04817f
AC
14205@c FIXME: JTC:
14206@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14207@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14208@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14209@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14210@c described. For example:
14211@c
14212@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14213@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14214@c otherwise returns current registers.
14215@c
14216@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14217@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14218@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14219
8e04817f
AC
14220@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14221@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
14222@tab
14223Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14224present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14225step starting at that address.
c906108c 14226
8e04817f
AC
14227@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14228@tab @code{I}
14229@tab
14230See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
c906108c 14231
8e04817f
AC
14232@item reserved
14233@tab @code{j}
14234@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14235
8e04817f
AC
14236@item reserved
14237@tab @code{J}
14238@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14239
8e04817f
AC
14240@item kill request
14241@tab @code{k}
14242@tab
ac282366 14243FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
6ca652b0 14244thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
c906108c 14245
8e04817f
AC
14246@item reserved
14247@tab @code{l}
14248@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14249
8e04817f
AC
14250@item reserved
14251@tab @code{L}
14252@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14253
8e04817f
AC
14254@item read memory
14255@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14256@tab
14257Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14258Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
14259using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14260transfer mechanism is needed.}
14261@item
14262@tab reply @var{XX...}
14263@tab
14264@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14265to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
14266sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
14267@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
14268@item
14269@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14270@tab @var{NN} is errno
c906108c 14271
8e04817f
AC
14272@item write mem
14273@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
14274@tab
14275Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14276@var{XX...} is the data.
14277@item
14278@tab reply @code{OK}
14279@tab for success
14280@item
14281@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14282@tab
14283for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14284written).
c906108c 14285
8e04817f
AC
14286@item reserved
14287@tab @code{n}
14288@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14289
8e04817f
AC
14290@item reserved
14291@tab @code{N}
14292@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14293
8e04817f
AC
14294@item reserved
14295@tab @code{o}
14296@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14297
8e04817f
AC
14298@item reserved
14299@tab @code{O}
14300@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14301
8e04817f
AC
14302@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14303@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
14304@tab
14305See write register.
14306@item
14307@tab return @var{r....}
14308@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
c906108c 14309
8e04817f
AC
14310@item write reg
14311@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
14312@tab
14313Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
14314digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14315@item
14316@tab reply @code{OK}
14317@tab for success
14318@item
14319@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14320@tab for an error
c906108c 14321
8e04817f
AC
14322@item general query
14323@tab @code{q}@var{query}
14324@tab
14325Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
14326have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
14327company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
14328optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
14329must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
14330@item
14331@tab reply @code{XX...}
14332@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14333@item
14334@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14335@tab error reply
14336@item
14337@tab reply @samp{}
14338@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
c906108c 14339
8e04817f
AC
14340@item general set
14341@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
14342@tab
14343Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
14344naming conventions.
c906108c 14345
8e04817f
AC
14346@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14347@tab @code{r}
14348@tab
14349Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14350
8e04817f
AC
14351@item remote restart
14352@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
14353@tab
14354Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14355This packet is only available in extended mode.
14356@item
14357@tab
14358no reply
14359@tab
14360The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
c906108c 14361
8e04817f
AC
14362@item step
14363@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
14364@tab
14365@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14366same address.
14367@item
14368@tab reply
14369@tab see below
c906108c 14370
8e04817f
AC
14371@item step with signal
14372@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14373@tab
14374Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14375@item
14376@tab reply
14377@tab see below
c906108c 14378
8e04817f
AC
14379@item search
14380@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
14381@tab
14382Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14383@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
14384bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14385
8e04817f
AC
14386@item thread alive
14387@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
14388@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14389@item
14390@tab reply @code{OK}
14391@tab thread is still alive
14392@item
14393@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14394@tab thread is dead
c906108c 14395
8e04817f
AC
14396@item reserved
14397@tab @code{u}
14398@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14399
8e04817f
AC
14400@item reserved
14401@tab @code{U}
14402@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14403
8e04817f
AC
14404@item reserved
14405@tab @code{v}
14406@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14407
8e04817f
AC
14408@item reserved
14409@tab @code{V}
14410@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14411
8e04817f
AC
14412@item reserved
14413@tab @code{w}
14414@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14415
8e04817f
AC
14416@item reserved
14417@tab @code{W}
14418@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14419
8e04817f
AC
14420@item reserved
14421@tab @code{x}
14422@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14423
8e04817f
AC
14424@item write mem (binary)
14425@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
14426@tab
14427@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
14428binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14429escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14430@item
14431@tab reply @code{OK}
14432@tab for success
14433@item
14434@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14435@tab for an error
c906108c 14436
8e04817f
AC
14437@item reserved
14438@tab @code{y}
14439@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14440
8e04817f
AC
14441@item reserved
14442@tab @code{Y}
14443@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14444
8e04817f
AC
14445@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14446@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14447@tab
14448See @samp{Z}.
c906108c 14449
8e04817f
AC
14450@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14451@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14452@tab
14453@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
14454breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
14455@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
14456bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
14457the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14458@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
14459potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
14460implemented in an idempotent way.
14461@item
14462@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14463@tab for an error
14464@item
14465@tab reply @code{OK}
14466@tab for success
14467@item
14468@tab @samp{}
14469@tab If not supported.
c906108c 14470
8e04817f
AC
14471@item reserved
14472@tab <other>
14473@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14474
8e04817f 14475@end multitable
c906108c 14476
8e04817f
AC
14477The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
14478receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
14479@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
14480when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
14481number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
14482conventions is used.
c906108c 14483
8e04817f 14484@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
c906108c 14485
8e04817f
AC
14486@item @code{S}@var{AA}
14487@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 14488
8e04817f
AC
14489@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
14490@tab
14491@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
14492(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
14493by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
14494thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
14495starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
14496@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
14497extend the protocol.
c906108c 14498
8e04817f
AC
14499@item @code{W}@var{AA}
14500@tab
14501The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
14502applicable for certains sorts of targets.
c906108c 14503
8e04817f
AC
14504@item @code{X}@var{AA}
14505@tab
14506The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 14507
8e04817f
AC
14508@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
14509@tab
14510@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
14511@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
14512@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
14513this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
14514spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
14515debugger.}
c906108c 14516
8e04817f
AC
14517@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
14518@tab
14519@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
14520while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
14521for 'W', 'T', etc.
c906108c 14522
8e04817f 14523@end multitable
c906108c 14524
8e04817f 14525The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 14526
8e04817f 14527@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
c906108c 14528
8e04817f
AC
14529@item current thread
14530@tab @code{q}@code{C}
14531@tab Return the current thread id.
14532@item
14533@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
14534@tab
14535Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
14536@item
14537@tab reply *
14538@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
c906108c 14539
8e04817f
AC
14540@item all thread ids
14541@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14542@item
14543@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
14544@tab
14545Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
14546may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
14547works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
14548obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
14549be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
14550sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
14551@item
14552@tab
14553@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
14554@item
14555@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
14556@tab A single thread id
14557@item
14558@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
14559@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
14560@item
14561@tab reply @code{l}
14562@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
14563@item
14564@tab
14565@tab
14566In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
14567or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
14568respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
14569@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
14570(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 14571
8e04817f
AC
14572@item extra thread info
14573@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
14574@tab
14575@item
14576@tab
14577@tab
14578Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
14579Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
14580the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
14581thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
14582The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
14583Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
14584"Blocked on Mutex".
14585@item
14586@tab reply @var{XX...}
14587@tab
14588Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
14589printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
14590attributes.
c906108c 14591
8e04817f
AC
14592@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
14593@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
14594@tab
14595@item
14596@tab
14597@tab
14598Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
14599digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
14600subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
14601number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
14602(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
14603returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
14604@item
14605@tab
14606@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14607query (see above).
14608@item
14609@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
14610@tab
14611@item
14612@tab
14613@tab
14614Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
14615returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
14616and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
14617digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
14618a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
14619digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
c906108c 14620
8e04817f
AC
14621@item compute CRC of memory block
14622@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14623@tab
14624@item
14625@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14626@tab An error (such as memory fault)
14627@item
14628@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
14629@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
c906108c 14630
8e04817f
AC
14631@item query sect offs
14632@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
14633@tab
14634Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
14635image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
14636response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
14637offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
14638@item
14639@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
c906108c 14640
8e04817f
AC
14641@item thread info request
14642@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
14643@tab
14644@item
14645@tab
14646@tab
14647Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
14648encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
14649@item
14650@tab reply *
14651@tab
14652See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 14653
8e04817f
AC
14654@item remote command
14655@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
14656@tab
14657@item
14658@tab
14659@tab
14660@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
14661execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
14662Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
14663number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
14664packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
14665stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
14666@item
14667@tab reply @code{OK}
14668@tab
14669A command response with no output.
14670@item
14671@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
14672@tab
14673A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
14674@item
14675@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14676@tab
14677Indicate a badly formed request.
c906108c 14678
8e04817f
AC
14679@item
14680@tab reply @samp{}
14681@tab
14682When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
c906108c 14683
8e04817f
AC
14684@item symbol lookup
14685@tab @code{qSymbol::}
14686@tab
14687Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
14688requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
14689@item
14690@tab
14691@tab
14692@item
14693@tab reply @code{OK}
14694@tab
14695The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14696@item
14697@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14698@tab
14699@sp 2
14700@noindent
14701The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14702@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
14703@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14704message, described below.
5d161b24 14705
8e04817f
AC
14706@item symbol value
14707@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14708@tab
14709@sp 1
14710@noindent
14711Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
14712@item
14713@tab
14714@tab
14715@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
14716the target has previously requested.
14717@item
14718@tab
14719@tab
14720@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
14721If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
14722field will be empty.
14723@item
14724@tab reply @code{OK}
14725@tab
14726The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14727@item
14728@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14729@tab
14730@sp 2
14731@noindent
14732The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14733@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
14734until the target ceases to request them.
eb12ee30 14735
8e04817f 14736@end multitable
eb12ee30 14737
8e04817f
AC
14738The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
14739In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
14740bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
14741space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
14742The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
14743least-significant.
eb12ee30 14744
8e04817f 14745@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
eb12ee30 14746
8e04817f
AC
14747@item MIPS32
14748@tab
14749All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1475032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
14751registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 14752
8e04817f
AC
14753@item MIPS64
14754@tab
14755All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
14756thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
14757as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 14758
8e04817f 14759@end multitable
eb12ee30 14760
8e04817f
AC
14761Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
14762does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 14763
474c8240 14764@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14765<- @code{R00}
14766-> @code{+}
14767@emph{target restarts}
14768<- @code{?}
14769-> @code{+}
14770-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14771<- @code{+}
474c8240 14772@end smallexample
eb12ee30 14773
8e04817f 14774Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 14775
474c8240 14776@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14777<- @code{G1445...}
14778-> @code{+}
14779<- @code{s}
14780-> @code{+}
14781@emph{time passes}
14782-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14783<- @code{+}
14784<- @code{g}
14785-> @code{+}
14786-> @code{1455...}
14787<- @code{+}
474c8240 14788@end smallexample
eb12ee30 14789
aab4e0ec 14790@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 14791
6826cf00
EZ
14792@include fdl.texi
14793
6d2ebf8b 14794@node Index
c906108c
SS
14795@unnumbered Index
14796
14797@printindex cp
14798
14799@tex
14800% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14801% meantime:
14802\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14803\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14804\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14805\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14806\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14807\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14808\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14809\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14810\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14811\page\colophon
14812% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14813@end tex
14814
c906108c 14815@bye
This page took 1.274787 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.